Sei sulla pagina 1di 298

VOLVO XC60

OWNERS MANUAL
WEB EDITION
Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dcIE&%..):c\a^h]!6I%.'%!Eg^ciZY^cHlZYZc!<ŽiZWdg\'%%.!8deng^\]i'%%%"'%%.Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dc
DEAR VOLVO OWNER
THANK YOU FOR CHOOSING VOLVO

We hope you will enjoy many years of driving pleasure in your


Volvo. The car has been designed for the safety and comfort of
you and your passengers. Volvo is one of the safest cars in the
world. Your Volvo has also been designed to satisfy all current
safety and environmental requirements.
In order to increase your enjoyment of the car, we recommend
that you familiarise yourself with the equipment, instructions
and maintenance information contained in this owner's manual.
Table of contents

00 01 02
00 Introduction 01 Safety 02 Locks and alarm
Important information................................. 6 Seatbelts .................................................. 16 Remote control key/key blade.................. 44
Volvo and the environment....................... 10 Airbag system (SRS - Airbag)................... 19 Battery replacement, remote control key/
Activating/deactivating the airbag*........... 22 PCC*......................................................... 49
Side airbags (SIPS bags) ......................... 24 Keyless drive*............................................ 51
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................... 26 Locking/unlocking..................................... 53
WHIPS ...................................................... 27 Child safety locks...................................... 58
Roll-Over Protection System - ROPS....... 29 Alarm*....................................................... 59
When the systems deploy ........................ 30
Safety mode.............................................. 31
Child safety............................................... 32

2 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Table of contents

03 04 05
03 Your driving environment 04 Comfort and driving pleasure 05 During your journey
Instruments and controls.......................... 64 Menus and messages............................. 120 Recommendations during driving........... 206
Key positions............................................ 73 Climate control........................................ 126 Refuelling................................................ 208
Seats......................................................... 75 Fuel-driven engine block heater and pas- Fuel......................................................... 209
Steering wheel.......................................... 79 senger compartment heater*.................. 133 Loading................................................... 212
Lighting..................................................... 80 Fuel-driven additional heater*................. 136 Cargo area.............................................. 213
Wipers and washing.................................. 89 Audio system.......................................... 137 Warning triangle*..................................... 217
Windows, rearview and door mirrors........ 92 Trip computer......................................... 150 Driving with a trailer................................ 218
Compass*................................................. 97 DSTC – Stability and traction control sys- Towing and recovery.............................. 224
tem.......................................................... 152
Power panorama roof* ............................. 98
Adapting driving characteristics............. 154
Starting the engine.................................. 100
Cruise control*........................................ 155
Starting the engine – external battery..... 102
Adaptive cruise control*.......................... 156
Gearboxes............................................... 103
Distance Alert.......................................... 162
All-wheel drive – AWD*........................... 107
City Safety™........................................... 165
Foot brake............................................... 108
Collision Warning with Auto Brake*........ 170
Hill Descent Control (HDC)..................... 110
Driver Alert System – DAC*..................... 175
Parking brake.......................................... 112
Driver Alert System - LDW*..................... 178
HomeLinkŸ *............................................ 115 Park assist syst*...................................... 181
Park assist camera*................................ 184
BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System. . 187
Comfort inside the passenger compart-
ment........................................................ 191
Bluetooth handsfree*.............................. 194
Built-in phone*........................................ 199

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 3


Table of contents

06 07 08
06 Maintenance and service 07 Specifications 08 Alphabetical Index
Engine compartment............................... 228 Type designations................................... 272 Alphabetical Index.................................. 286
Lamps..................................................... 234 Dimensions and weights......................... 274
Wiper blades and washer fluid................ 241 Engine specifications.............................. 277
Battery..................................................... 243 Engine oil................................................ 278
Fuses...................................................... 246 Fluids and lubricants............................... 280
Wheels and tyres.................................... 254 Fuel......................................................... 282
Car care.................................................. 265 Electrical system..................................... 283
Type approval......................................... 284

4
Table of contents

5
Introduction

Important information

Reading the Owner's Manual Option Footnote


All types of option/accessory are marked with There is footnote information in the owner's
Introduction an asterisk . manual that is located at the bottom of the
A good way of getting to know your new car is page. This information is an addition to the text
to read the owner's manual, ideally before your The range of options/accessories for the dif- that it refers to via a number. If the footnote
first journey. This will give you the opportunity ferent car models varies depending on the mar- refers to text in a table then letters are used
to familiarise yourself with new functions, to ket. The majority of options are factory fitted instead of numbers for referral.
see how best to handle the car in different sit- and cannot be retrofitted, accessories are ret-
uations, and to make the best use of all the rofitted. Message texts
car's features. Please pay attention to the We recommend that you contact your author- There are displays in the car that show text
safety instructions contained in the manual. ised Volvo dealer for more information. messages. These text messages are high-
The equipment described in the owner's man- lighted in the owner's manual by means of the
ual is not present in all cars. In addition to Special texts text being slightly larger and printed in grey.
standard equipment, this manual also Examples of this are in menu texts and mes-
describes options (factory fitted equipment) WARNING sage texts on the information display (e.g.
and certain accessories (retrofitted extra Audio settings).
Warning texts advise of a risk of personal
equipment). If you are uncertain over what is injury. Decals
standard or option/accessory then we recom- The car contains different types of decal which
mend that you contact your Volvo dealer. are designed to convey important information
IMPORTANT
Volvo cars are adapted for the varying require- in a simple and clear manner. The decals in the
ments of different markets, as well as for Important texts advise of a risk of material car have the following descending degree of
national or local legal requirements and regu- damage. importance for the warning/information.
lations.
The specifications, design features and illus- NOTE
trations in this owner's manual are not binding. NOTE texts give advice or tips that facilitate
We reserve the right to make modifications the use of features and functions for exam-
without prior notice. ple.
© Volvo Car Corporation

6
Introduction

Important information

Warning for personal injury Risk of property damage Information

Black ISO symbols on yellow warning field, White ISO symbols and white text/image on White ISO symbols and white text/image on
white text/image on black message field. Used black or blue warning field and message field. black message field.
to indicate the presence of danger which, if the Used to indicate the presence of danger which,
warning is ignored, may result in serious per- if the warning is ignored, may result in damage NOTE
sonal injury or fatality. to property.
The labels shown in the owner's manual are
not provided as exact reproductions of
those in the car. The purpose is to show
their approximate appearance and location
in the car. The information that applies to
your car in particular is available on the label
in question in your car.

Procedure lists
Procedures where action must be taken in a
certain sequence are numbered in the owner's
manual.

7
Introduction

Important information

When there is a series of illustrations for To be continued Accessories and extra equipment
step-by-step instructions each step is `` This symbol is located furthest down to the The incorrect connection and installation of
numbered in the same way as the corres- right when a section continues on the following accessories can negatively affect the car's
ponding illustration. page. electrical system. Certain accessories only
There are numbered lists with letters adja- function when their associated software is
cent to the series of illustrations where the Recording data installed in the car's computer system. We
order of the instructions is not significant. therefore recommend that you always contact
The driving and safety systems in the car use
Arrows appear numbered and unnum- an authorised Volvo workshop before installing
computers which check and share information
bered and are used to illustrate a move- accessories which are connected to or affect
with each other on the car's function. One or
ment. the electrical system.
more of these computers may store informa-
If there is no series of illustrations for step-by- tion on the systems they check during normal
step instructions then the different steps are driving, during the course of a collision or near- Laser sensor
numbered with normal numbers. collision. Stored information may be used by: This vehicle is equipped with a sensor which
• Volvo Car Corporation transmits laser light. It is absolutely essential to
Position lists follow the prescribed instructions when han-
Red circles containing a number are used • Service or repair workshops
dling the laser sensor.
in overview images where different com- • Police or other authorities
ponents are pointed out. The number The following two decals relate to the laser
• Other parties who claim legal entitlement sensor:
recurs in the position list featured in con- for access to the information or someone
nection with the illustration that describes who has permission from the owner to
the item. access the information.
Bulleted lists
A bulleted list is used when there is a list of
points in the owner's manual.
Example:
• Coolant
• Engine oil

G033853
8
Introduction

Important information

• The upper decal describes the laser light's WARNING • The laser sensor's connector must be
classification, Invisible Laser radiation – Do unplugged before removal from the
not view directly with optical instruments If any of these instructions are not followed windscreen.
(magnifiers) – Class 1M laser product. then there is a risk of eye injury!
• The laser sensor must be fitted onto the
This text is printed in the next warning box. • Never look into the laser sensor (which windscreen before the sensor's con-
emits spreading invisible laser radiation) nector is plugged in.
• The lower decal describes the laser light's at a distance of 100 mm or closer with
physical data: magnifying optics such as a magnifying • The laser sensor transmits laser light
IEC 60825-1:1993 + A2:2001. Complies when the remote control key is in posi-
glass, microscope, lens or similar opti-
with FDA performance standards for laser tion II and also with the engine switched
cal instruments.
products except for deviations pursuant to off (see page 73 on key positions).
Laser Notice No. 50, dated • Testing, repair, removal, adjustment
July 26th, 2001. and/or replacement of the laser sen-
sor's spare parts must only be carried For more information on the laser sensor, see
The physical data is specified in the following out by a qualified workshop - we rec- page 165.
table and other text is printed in the next warn- ommend an authorised Volvo work-
ing box. shop. Information on the Internet
Radiation data for the laser sensor • To avoid exposure to harmful radiation, At www.volvocars.com there is further infor-
do not carry out any readjustments or mation concerning your car.
Maximum pulse energy 2.64 μJ maintenance other than those specified
here.
Maximum average output 45 mW
• The repairer must follow specially
Pulse duration 33 ns drawn up workshop information for the
laser sensor.
Divergence (horizontal × verti- 28° × 12°
cal) • Do not remove the laser sensor (this
includes removing the lenses). A
removed laser sensor does not fulfil
laser class 3B as per standard IEC
60825-1. Laser class 3B is not eye-safe
and therefore entails a risk of injury.

9
Introduction

Volvo and the environment

Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy

G000000
Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corpo- Fuel consumption many cases the exhaust emissions are well
ration's core values which influence all opera- Volvo cars have competitive fuel consumption below the applicable standards.
tions. We also believe that our customers share in each of their respective classes. Lower fuel
our consideration for the environment. consumption generally results in lower emis- Clean air in the passenger compartment
sion of the greenhouse gas, carbon dioxide. A passenger compartment filter prevents dust
Your Volvo complies with strict international and pollen from entering the passenger com-
environmental standards and is also manufac- It is possible for the driver to influence fuel con- partment via the air intake.
tured in one of the cleanest and most resource- sumption. For more information read under the
efficient plants in the world. Volvo Car Corpo- heading, Reducing environmental impact. A sophisticated air quality system, IAQS* (Inte-
ration has global ISO certification, which rior Air Quality System) ensures that the incom-
includes the environmental standard ISO Efficient emission control ing air is cleaner than the air in the traffic out-
14001 covering all factories and several of our Your Volvo is manufactured following the con- side.
other units. We also set requirements for our cept "Clean inside and out" – a concept that The system consists of an electronic sensor
partners so that they work systematically with encompasses a clean interior environment as and a carbon filter. The incoming air is moni-
environmental issues. well as highly efficient emission control. In tored continuously and if there is an increase in

10 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Introduction

Volvo and the environment

the level of certain unhealthy gases such as nance of your car it becomes part of our sys- cold. This reduces fuel consumption and
carbon monoxide then the air intake is closed. tem. We make clear demands regarding the exhaust emissions.
Such a situation may arise in heavy traffic, way in which our workshops are designed in • Drive gently and avoid braking too hard.
queues and tunnels for example. order to prevent spills and discharges into the
environment. Our workshop staff have the
• Drive in the highest gear possible. Low
The entry of nitrous oxides, ground-level ozone engine speeds result in lower fuel con-
knowledge and the tools required to guarantee sumption.
and hydrocarbons is prevented by the carbon
good environmental care.
filter. • Use engine braking to slow down.
Reducing environmental impact • Avoid letting the engine idle. Pay attention
Textile standard
You can easily help reduce environmental to local regulations. Switch off the engine
The interior of a Volvo is designed to be plea-
impact, for example, by driving economically when stationary for longer periods.
sant and comfortable, even for people with
and by servicing and maintaining the car
contact allergies and for asthma sufferers. • Always dispose of environmentally hazar-
according to the instructions in the owner's dous waste, such as batteries and oils, in
Extreme attention has been given to choosing
manual. an environmentally safe manner. We rec-
environmentally-compatible materials. This
means that they also fulfil the requirements in The following advice will help you to do your bit ommend that you consult an authorised
the Oeko-Tex 100 standard1, a major advance for the environment: (for further advice on how Volvo workshop for advice if you are uncer-
towards a healthier passenger compartment you can reduce environmental impact and tain about the disposal of this type of
environment. drive economically, see pages 264, 206). waste.

Oeko-Tex certification covers seatbelts, car- • Decrease fuel consumption by choosing


• Service your car regularly.
pets and fabrics for example. The leather in the ECO tyre pressure, see page 264. • High speed increases consumption con-
upholstery undergoes chromium-free tanning siderably due to increased wind resis-
• A roof load and ski box increase air resis-
tance. A doubling of speed increases wind
with plant substances and fulfils the certifica- tance, leading to higher fuel consumption.
resistance 4 times.
tion requirements. Remove them directly after use.
These hints will help reduce fuel consumption
Volvo workshops and the environment • Remove unnecessary items from the car.
without increasing travel time or lessening the
The greater the load the higher the fuel
Regular maintenance creates the conditions enjoyment of driving. Apart from being kind to
consumption.
for a long service life and low fuel consumption your car, you'll be saving money - and the
for your car. In this way you contribute to a • If the car is equipped with an engine block Earth's resources.
cleaner environment. When Volvo's workshops heater, always use it before starting from
are entrusted with the service and mainte-

1 More information on www.oekotex.com

11
Introduction

Volvo and the environment

The owner's manual and the


environment
The FSC symbol shows that the paper pulp in
this publication comes from FSC certified for-
ests or other controlled sources.

12
Introduction

13
Seatbelts ................................................................................................ 16
Airbag system (SRS - Airbag)................................................................. 19
Activating/deactivating the airbag*......................................................... 22
Side airbags (SIPS bags) ....................................................................... 24
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................................................................. 26
WHIPS .................................................................................................... 27
Roll-Over Protection System - ROPS..................................................... 29
When the systems deploy ...................................................................... 30
Safety mode............................................................................................ 31

G020871
Child safety............................................................................................. 32

14 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


SAFETY

01
01 Safety

01 Seatbelts

General information Releasing the seatbelt WARNING


Press the red lock button and then let the seat-
belt retract. If the seatbelt does not retract fully, Each seatbelt is designed for only one per-
son.
feed the seatbelt in by hand so that it does not
hang loose.
The seatbelt locks and cannot be withdrawn: WARNING
• if it is pulled out too quickly Never modify or repair the seatbelts your-
self. Volvo recommends that you contact an
• during braking and acceleration authorised Volvo workshop.
• if the car leans heavily. If a seatbelt has been subjected to a major
load, such as in conjunction with a collision,
Keep in mind the following the entire seatbelt must be replaced. Some
• do not use clips or anything else that can of the protective characteristics of the seat-
prevent the seatbelt from fitting properly belt may have been lost, even if it appears
Heavy braking can have serious consequences to be undamaged. In addition, replace the
if the seatbelts are not used. Ensure that all • ensure that the seatbelt is not twisted or
seatbelt if the belt is worn or damaged. The
caught on anything
passengers use their seatbelts. new seatbelt must be type-approved and
• the hip strap must be positioned low down intended for installation in the same position
It is important that the seatbelt lies against the (not over the abdomen) as the replaced seatbelt.
body so it can provide maximum protection.
Do not lean the backrest too far back. The • tension the hip strap over the lap by pulling
the diagonal shoulder belt as in the pre-
seatbelt is designed to protect in a normal
ceding illustration.
seating position.

Putting on a seatbelt WARNING


Pull the seatbelt out slowly and secure it by The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seat-
pressing the buckle into the lock. A loud "click" belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this
indicates that the seatbelt has locked. may diminish the protection provided by the
airbag in the event of a collision.
The buckles only fit the intended lock in the rear
seat*.

16 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


01 Safety

Seatbelts 01

Seatbelts and pregnancy tion the seat with as large a distance as possi- Rear seat
ble between abdomen and steering wheel. The seatbelt reminder in the rear seat has two
subfunctions:
Seatbelt reminder • Provides information on which seatbelts
are being used in the rear seat. The mes-
sage is shown in the information display
when the seatbelts are being used or when
a rear door is opened. The message is
automatically cleared after approx. 30 sec-
onds or can be acknowledged manually by
pressing the direction indicator lever's

G020998
READ button.
• Provides a warning if one of the rear seat-
belts is unfastened during travel. This
The seatbelt should always be worn during

G017726
warning takes the form of a message on
pregnancy. But it is then crucial that it be worn
the information display along with the
in the correct way. The diagonal section should audio/visual signal. The warning stops
wrap over the shoulder then be routed between Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten when the seatbelt is re-fastened, or it can
the breasts and to the side of the abdomen. their seatbelts by means of an audio and visual also be acknowledged manually by press-
The lap section should lay flat over the thighs reminder. The audio reminder is speed ing the READ button.
and as low as possible under the abdomen. – dependent, and in some cases time depend- The message on the information display show-
It must never be allowed to ride upward. ent. The visual reminder is located in the roof ing which seatbelts are in use is always avail-
Remove all slack from the seatbelt and ensure console and the combined instrument panel. able. Press the READ button to see stored
that it fits close to the body. In addition, check Child seats are not covered by the seatbelt messages.
that there are no twists in the seatbelt. reminder system.
As the pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers
should adjust their seats and steering wheel
such that they can easily maintain control of the
vehicle as they drive (which means that they
must be able to easily operate the foot pedals
and steering wheel). The aim should be to posi-

``

17
01 Safety

01 Seatbelts

Certain markets
An acoustic signal and indicator lamp remind
the driver and front seat passenger to use a
seatbelt if either of them is not wearing one. At
low speed, the audio reminder will sound for
the first 6 seconds.

Seatbelt tensioner
All the seatbelts are equipped with belt ten-
sioners. A mechanism in the seatbelt tensioner
tightens the seatbelt in the event of a suffi-
ciently violent collision. The seatbelt then pro-
vides more effective restraint for the occu-
pants.

18
01 Safety

Airbag system (SRS - Airbag) 01

Warning symbol on the combined WARNING Overview, airbag system


instrument panel
If the warning symbol for the airbag system
remains illuminated or illuminates while driv-
ing, it means that the airbag system does
not have full functionality. The symbol indi-
cates a fault in the seatbelt tensioner sys-
tem, SIPS, the IC system or another fault in
the SRS system. Volvo recommends that
0 1
you contact an authorised Volvo workshop
o

immediately.

G018665
As well as the warning symbol, a message may

G021010
appear on the information display in appropri-
ate cases. If the warning symbol malfunctions, SRS system, left-hand drive.
the warning triangle illuminates and SRS
The airbag system is continuously monitored Airbag Service required or SRS Airbag
by the system's control module. The warning Service urgent appears in the display. Volvo
symbol in the combined instrument panel illu- recommends that you contact an authorised
minates when the remote control key is in posi- Volvo workshop immediately.
tion II or III. The symbol clears after
approx. 6 seconds provided the airbag system
is fault-free.

G018666
SRS system, right-hand drive.
The SRS system consists of airbags and sen-
sors. A sufficiently violent collision trips the
sensors and the airbag(s) are inflated with hot

``

19
01 Safety

01 Airbag system (SRS - Airbag)

gas. To cushion the impact, the airbag deflates Airbag on the driver's side
when compressed. When this occurs, smoke
escapes into the car. This is completely nor-
mal. The entire process, including inflation and
deflation of the airbag, occurs within tenths of
a second.

WARNING
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop for repair.
Defective work in the airbag system could

G021011
cause malfunction and result in serious per-
sonal injury. Location of the front passenger airbag in a left-
hand drive car.
The car has an SRS airbag (Supplemental
NOTE Restraint System) to supplement the protec-
The sensors react differently depending on tion afforded by the seatbelt on the driver's
the course of the collision and whether or side. This airbag is fitted into the centre of the
not the seatbelts on the driver and passen- steering wheel. The steering wheel is marked
ger side are used. SRS AIRBAG.
It is therefore possible that only one (or
none) of the airbags may inflate in a colli- WARNING
sion. The airbag system senses the force of
the collision on the car and adapts accord- The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seat-
ingly so that one or more airbags are belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this
deployed. may diminish the protection provided by the
airbag in the event of a collision.
The capacity of the airbags is also adapted
Location of the front passenger airbag in a right-
to the collision force to which the vehicle is
hand drive car.
subjected.

20
01 Safety

Airbag system (SRS - Airbag) 01

Passenger airbag WARNING Label Airbag


Do not put objects in front of or above the
dashboard where the passenger airbag is
located.

WARNING
Never place a child in a child seat or on a
booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag
is activated1.
Never allow a child to stand or sit in front of

G032244
the front passenger seat. No one shorter
than 140 cm should ever sit in the front pas-
senger seat if the airbag is activated. Label for airbag located on door pillar.
The car has an airbag to supplement the pro-
tection afforded by the seatbelt on the passen- Failure to follow the advice given above
ger side. This airbag is folded up into a com- could endanger the life of the child.
partment above the glovebox. Its cover panel
is marked SRS AIRBAG.

WARNING
To minimise the risk of injury if the airbag
deploys, passengers must sit as upright as
possible with their feet on the floor and
backs against the backrest. Seatbelts must
be secured.

1 For information on how to activate/deactivate the airbag, see page 22.

21
01 Safety

01 Activating/deactivating the airbag*

Key switch off - PACOS WARNING Activating/deactivating


General information If the car is equipped with a front passenger
The airbag for the front passenger seat can be airbag, but has no switch (PACOS, Passen-
deactivated if the car is equipped with a switch, ger Airbag Cut Off Switch), then the airbag
is always activated.
PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch). For
information on how to activate/deactivate, see
under the heading Activating/deactivating. WARNING
Key switch off/switch Never place a child in a child seat or on a
The switch for the passenger airbag (PACOS) booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag
is located on the passenger end of the instru- is activated and the symbol in the roof

G032072
ment panel and is accessible when the pas- console is illuminated. Failure to follow this
advice could endanger the life of the child.
senger door is open, (see under the following
Switch location.
heading, "Switch – PACOS"). Check that the
switch is in the required position. Volvo rec- WARNING The airbag is activated. With the switch in
ommends that the remote control key's key this position, persons taller than 140 cm
blade be used to change position. Do not allow anyone to sit in the front pas- can sit in the front passenger seat, but
senger seat if the message in the roof panel never children in a child seat or on a
For information on the key blade, see (see page 23) indicates that the airbag is
booster cushion.
page 47. deactivated and if the warning symbol for
the airbag system is also displayed in the The airbag is deactivated. With the switch
combined instrument panel. This indicates in this position, children in a child seat or
WARNING that there has been a severe malfunction. on a booster cushion can sit in the front
Failure to follow the advice given above Visit a workshop as soon as possible. Volvo passenger seat, but never persons taller
could endanger the life of passengers in the recommends that you contact an author-
than 140 cm.
car. ised Volvo workshop.

22 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


01 Safety

Activating/deactivating the airbag* 01

WARNING A text message and a symbol in the roof panel NOTE


indicate that the airbag for the front passenger
Activated airbag (passenger seat): seat is deactivated (see preceding illustration). When the remote control key is turned to
ignition position II or III the warning symbol
Never place a child in a child seat or on a
for the airbag is shown in the combined
booster cushion on the front passenger seat
instrument panel for approx. 6 seconds (see
when the airbag is activated. This applies to
page 19).
everyone shorter than 140 cm.
Following which, the indicator in the roof
Deactivated airbag (passenger seat):
console is illuminated showing the correct
No one taller than 140 cm should ever sit in status for the front passenger seat airbag.
the front passenger seat when the airbag is For more information on the remote control
deactivated. key's different ignition positions, see
page 73.
Failure to follow the advice given above
could endanger life.

G017800
Messages
Indicator in the roof console showing that the pas-
senger airbag is activated.
A warning symbol in the roof panel indicates
2 that the airbag for the front passenger seat is
activated (see preceding illustration).

2
G017724

Indicator in the roof console showing that the pas-


senger airbag is deactivated.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 23


01 Safety

01 Side airbags (SIPS bags)

Side airbag WARNING Location


• Volvo recommends that repairs are only
carried out by an authorised Volvo
workshop. Defective work in the SIPS-
bag system could cause malfunction
and result in serious personal injury.
• Do not put objects in the area between
the outside of the seat and the door
panel, since this area is required by the
side airbag.

G024377

G032949
Volvo recommends the use only of car
seat covers approved by Volvo. Other
seat covers may impede the operation Driver's seat, left-hand drive.
In a side impact collision a large proportion of of the side airbags.
the collision force is transferred by the SIPS • The side airbag is a supplement to the
(Side Impact Protection System) to beams, pil- seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt.
lars, the floor, the roof and other structural
parts of the body. The side airbags at the driv-
er's and front passenger seats protect the Child seats and side airbags
chest area and the hip and are an important The protection provided by the car to children
part of the SIPS. seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion
is not diminished by the side airbag.
The SIPS bag system consists of two main
components, side airbag and sensors. The A child seat or booster cushion can be placed
on the front passenger seat provided that the

G024378
side airbags are located in the front seat backr-
ests. car does not have an activated1 passenger air-
bag.
Front passenger seat, left-hand drive.
The SIPS bag system consists of side airbags
and sensors. A sufficiently violent collision trips

1 For information on activating/deactivating the airbag, see page 22.

24
01 Safety

Side airbags (SIPS bags) 01

the sensors and the side airbags are inflated.


The airbag inflates between the occupant and
the door panel and thereby cushions the initial
impact. The airbag deflates when compressed
by the collision. The side airbag is normally only
deployed on the side of the collision.

Label, side airbag

G032254

Label for side airbag located on door pillar.

25
01 Safety

01 Inflatable Curtain (IC)

Properties WARNING
Never hang or attach heavy items onto the
handles in the roof. The hook is only
designed for light clothing (not for solid
objects such as umbrellas for example).
Do not screw or install anything onto the
car's headlining, door pillars or side panels.
This could compromise the intended pro-
tection. Volvo recommends that you only
ever use Volvo genuine parts that are
approved for placement in these areas.

WARNING
The inflatable curtain (IC) is a supplement to the Do not load the car higher than 50 mm under
SIPS and SRS airbags. It is fitted in the head- the top edge of the door windows. Other-
lining along both sides of the roof and protects wise, the intended protection of the inflat-
the car occupants sitting in the outer seats. A able curtain, which is concealed in the head-
sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors lining, may be compromised.
and the inflatable curtain is inflated. The inflat-
able curtain helps to prevent the driver and
WARNING
passengers from striking their heads on the
inside of the car during a collision. The inflatable curtain is a supplement to the
seatbelts.
Always use a seatbelt.

26
01 Safety

WHIPS 01

Protection against whiplash injury – The whiplash protection system (WHIPS) con- Correct seating position
WHIPS sists of energy absorbing backrests and spe- For the best possible protection, the driver and
cially designed head restraints in the front front seat passenger should sit in the centre of
seats. The system is actuated by a rear-end the seat with as little space as possible
collision, where the angle and speed of the col- between the head and the head restraint.
lision, and the nature of the colliding vehicle all
have an influence. Do not obstruct the WHIPS system

WARNING
The WHIPS system is a supplement to the
seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt.

Properties of the seat


When the WHIPS system is deployed, the front
seat backrests are lowered backward to alter
the seating position of the driver and front seat
passenger. This reduces the risk of whiplash
injury.
Do not leave any objects on the floor behind the
WARNING driver's seat or the passenger seat.

Never modify or repair the seat or WHIPS WARNING


system yourself. Volvo recommends that
you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. Do not squeeze rigid objects between the
rear seat cushion and the front seat back-
rest. Make sure you do not to obstruct the
WHIPS system and child seats/booster function of the WHIPS system.
cushions
The protection provided by the car to children
seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion
is not diminished by the WHIPS system.

``

27
01 Safety

01 WHIPS

WARNING
If a seat has been subjected to extreme
forces, such as due to a rear-end collision,
the WHIPS system must be checked. Volvo
recommends that it is checked by an
authorised Volvo workshop.
Part of the WHIPS system's protective
capacity may have been lost even if the
seats appear to be undamaged.
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop to have the sys-
tem checked even after a minor rear-end
Do not leave any objects on the rear seat. collision.

WARNING
If a rear seat backrest is folded down, the
corresponding front seat must be moved
forward so that it does not touch the folded
backrest.

28
01 Safety

Roll-Over Protection System - ROPS 01

Function
Volvo's Roll-Over Protection System (ROPS)
has been designed to reduce the risk of the car
overturning and to provide the best possible
protection in the event of such an accident.
The system consists of a stabiliser system,
Roll Stability Control (RSC) that minimises the
risk of overturning, for example, during sudden
evasive manoeuvres or if the car skids.
The RSC system uses a sensor which registers
changes in the car's lateral inclination angle.
This information is used to calculate the risk of
the car overturning. If a risk exists, the DSTC
system engages, engine torque is lowered and
one or more wheels are braked until the car has
regained its stability.
Read more about the DSTC system on page
152.

WARNING
Under normal driving conditions, the RSC
system improves the car's road safety, but
this must not be taken as a reason to
increase speed. Always follow the usual
precautions for safe driving.

29
01 Safety

01 When the systems deploy

When the systems deploy • Recovering the car. Volvo recommends WARNING
that you have it conveyed to an authorised
System Triggered Volvo workshop. Do not drive with Never drive with deployed airbags. They
deployed airbags. can make steering difficult. Other safety
Seatbelt tensioner, In the event of a systems may also be damaged. The smoke
front seat frontal collision, • Volvo recommends that you engage an and dust created when the airbags are
and/or side-impact authorised Volvo workshop to handle the deployed can cause skin and eye irritation/
collision, and/or replacement of components in the car's injury after intensive exposure. In case of
rear-end collision safety systems. irritation, wash with cold water. The rapid
deployment sequence and airbag fabric
and/or overturning • Always contact a doctor.
may cause friction and skin burns.
Seatbelt tensioner, In the event of a NOTE
rear seat frontal collision and/
or overturning The SRS, SIPS, IC and belt tensioner sys-
tems are deployed only once during a colli-
Airbags (SRS) In a frontal collisionA sion.

Side airbags (SIPS) In a side-impact


accident WARNING
The airbag control module is located in the
Inflatable Curtain IC In the event of a centre console. If the centre console is
side-impact colli- drenched with water or other liquid, discon-
sion and/or over- nect the battery cables. Do not attempt to
turning start the car since the airbags may deploy.
Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that
Whiplash protection In a rear-end colli- you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo
WHIPS sion workshop.
A The bodywork of the car could be greatly deformed in a col-
lision without airbag deployment. A number of factors such
as the rigidity and weight of the object hit, the speed of the
car, the angle of the collision etc. affects how the different
safety systems of the car are activated.

If the airbags have deployed, the following is


recommended:

30
01 Safety

Safety mode 01

Reduced functionality reset themselves to normal mode. Then try to WARNING


start the car. If the message Safety mode See
manual is still shown on the display then the If the car is in safety mode it must not be
towed. It must be transported from its loca-
car must not be driven or towed, but a vehicle
tion. Volvo recommends that it is transpor-
recovery service used instead. Even if the car ted to an authorised Volvo workshop.
appears to be driveable, hidden damage may
make the car impossible to control once mov-
ing.

Moving the car


If Normal mode is shown after Safety mode
See manual has been reset, the car can be

G021062
moved carefully out of a dangerous position.
Do not move the car further than necessary.
If the car is involved in a collision, the text
Safety mode See manual may appear on the WARNING
information display. This means that the car
Never attempt to repair your car or reset the
has reduced functionality. Safety mode is a
electronics yourself if the car has been in
protective state that is enforced when the col- safety mode. This could result in personal
lision may have damaged any of the car's vital injury or the car not functioning as normal.
functions, such as the fuel lines, sensors for Volvo recommends that you engage an
one of the safety systems, or the brake system. authorised Volvo workshop to check and
restore the car to normal status after Safety
Attempting to start the car mode See manual has been displayed.
First, check that no fuel is leaking from the car.
There must be no smell of fuel either.
WARNING
If everything seems normal and you have
checked for indications of fuel leakage, you Never, under any circumstances, attempt to
restart the car if it smells of fuel when the
may attempt to start the car.
Safety mode message is displayed. Leave
Firstly, remove the remote control key and then the car at once.
reinsert it. The car's electronics will then try to

31
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Children should sit comfortably and Child seats Location of child seats
safely You may place:
The position of a child in the car and the choice
• a child seat/booster cushion on the pas-
of equipment are dictated by the child's weight senger seat, provided the passenger air-
and size, for more information, see page 33. bag is not activated1.

NOTE • a rear-facing child seat in the rear seat.


Always place a child in the rear seat if the pas-
Regulations regarding the placement of senger airbag is activated. A child sitting on the
children in cars vary from country to coun-
front passenger seat could suffer serious injury
try. Check what does apply.
if the airbag deploys.

G020739
Children of all ages and sizes must always sit WARNING
correctly secured in the car. Never allow a child Child seats and airbags are not compatible.
to sit on the knee of a passenger. Never place a child in a child seat or on a
Volvo has child safety products that are booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag
Volvo's own child safety equipment is designed for and tested by Volvo. (SRS) is activated.
designed for your car. Volvo recommends that
No one shorter than 140 cm should ever sit
you use Volvo genuine equipment to best in the front passenger seat if the airbag
NOTE
ensure that the mounting points and attach- (SRS) is activated.
ments are correctly positioned and are suffi- When using child safety products it is
important to read the installation instruc- Failure to follow the advice given above
ciently strong.
tions included. could endanger the life of the child.

NOTE
Do not attach the straps for the child seat to
In the event of questions when fitting child the horizontal adjustment bar, springs, rails or
safety products, contact the manufacturer
for clearer instructions. beams under the seat. Sharp edges can dam-
age the straps.
Look in the installation instructions for the child
seat for the correct fitting.

1 For information on activated/deactivated airbag (SRS), see page 22.

32
01 Safety

Child safety 01

WARNING Label Airbag


Booster cushions/child seats with steel
braces or some other design that could rest
on the seatbelt buckle's opening button
must not be used, as they could cause the
seatbelt buckle to open accidentally.
Do not allow the upper section of the child Label located on instrument panel end face on the
seat to rest against the windscreen. passenger side.

Recommended child seats2


Weight/Age Front seat Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
Group 0 Volvo Child seat – rear-facing child Volvo Child seat – rear-facing child
seat, secured with the car's seatbelt seat, secured with the car's seatbelt,
max 10 kg
and straps. straps and support legs.
(0 – 9 months)
Type approval: E5 03135 Type approval: E5 03135
and
Volvo infant seat - rear-facing child Volvo infant seat - rear-facing child Volvo infant seat – rear-facing child
Group 0+ seat, secured with the ISOFIX fixture seat, secured with the ISOFIX fixture seat, secured with the car's seatbelt.
max 13 kg system. system.
Type approval: E1 03301146
Type approval: E1 03301146 Type approval: E1 03301146

Volvo infant seat – rear-facing child Volvo infant seat – rear-facing child
seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. seat, secured with the car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E1 03301146 Type approval: E1 03301146

2 With regard to other child seats your car should be included in the manufacturer's enclosed list of vehicles or be universally approved in accordance with the ECE R44 legal requirement.
``

33
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Weight/Age Front seat Outer rear seat Centre rear seat


Group 1 Volvo Child seat – rear-facing child Volvo Child seat – rear-facing child
seat, secured with the car's seatbelt seat, secured with the car's seatbelt,
9-18 kg
and straps. straps and support legs.
(9-36 months)
Type approval: E5 03135 Type approval: E5 03135

Volvo turnable child seat – rear-facing Volvo turnable child seat – rear-facing
child seat, secured with the car's seat- child seat, secured with the car's seat-
belt and straps. belt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192

Britax Fixway – rear-facing child seat, Britax Fixway – rear-facing child seat,
secured with the ISOFIX fixture system secured with the ISOFIX fixture system
and straps. and straps.
Type approval: E5 03171 Type approval: E5 03171

Group 2, 15-25 kg, 3-6 Volvo turnable child seat - front-facing Volvo turnable child seat - front-facing Volvo turnable child seat - front-facing
yr child seat, secured with the car's seat- child seat, secured with the car's seat- child seat, secured with the car's seat-
belt. belt. belt.
Type approval: E5 04191 Type approval: E5 04191 Type approval: E5 04191

Volvo turnable child seat – rear-facing Volvo turnable child seat – rear-facing
child seat, secured with the car's seat- child seat, secured with the car's seat-
belt and straps. belt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192

34
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Weight/Age Front seat Outer rear seat Centre rear seat


Group 2/3 Volvo Booster cushion – with or with- Volvo Booster cushion – with or with- Volvo Booster cushion – with or with-
out backrest. out backrest. out backrest.
15-36 kg
Type approval: E5 03139 Type approval: E5 03139 Type approval: E5 03139
(3-12 yr)
Volvo booster cushion with backrest. Volvo booster cushion with backrest. Volvo booster cushion with backrest.
Type approval: E1 04301198 Type approval: E1 04301198 Type approval: E1 04301198

Volvo 2-stage Integrated booster


cushion – available as a factory fitted
option.
Type approval: E5 04189

Integrated two-stage booster The booster cushions are specially designed to


cushions* provide optimum safety. In combination with
the seatbelt they are approved for children who
weigh between 15 and 36 kg and who are 95
to 140 cm in height.
Check before driving that:
• the 2-stage integrated booster cushion is
correctly set (see table below) and in
locked position

G017719
• the seatbelt is in contact with the child's
body and is not slack or twisted
G017875

Incorrect position, the head must not be posi-


tioned above the head restraint and the seatbelt
must not be below the shoulder.
Correct position, the seatbelt is positioned above
the shoulder.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 35


01 Safety

01 Child safety

• the seatbelt does not lie across the child's Pull the handle forward and up in order to Start from the lower stage. Press the but-
throat or below the shoulder (see preced- release the booster cushion. ton.
ing illustrations)
• the lap section of the seatbelt is positioned
low over the pelvis to provide optimal pro-
tection.

Stage 1 Stage 2
Weight 22-36 kg 15-25 kg

Length 115-140 cm 95-120 cm

G017697

G017784
For instructions on adjusting the booster cush-
ion's two levels, see pages 35–37.

Raising the two-stage booster cushion Press the booster cushion backwards to Lift the booster cushion up at the front edge
Stage 1 lock. and press it back against the backrest to lock.
Stage 2
WARNING
Volvo recommends that repair or replace-
ment is only carried out by an authorised
Volvo workshop. Do not make any modifi-
cations or additions to the booster cushion.
If an integrated booster cushion has been
subjected to a major load, such as in con-
junction with a collision, the entire booster
cushion must be replaced. Even if the
booster cushion appears to be undamaged,
it may not afford the same level of protec-
tion. The booster cushion must also be
replaced if it is heavily worn.

36
01 Safety

Child safety 01

NOTE Child safety locks, rear doors


The controls for operating the rear door power
It is not possible to adjust the booster cush-
ion from stage 2 to stage 1. It must first be windows and the rear door opening handles
reset by being fully folded into the seat can be blocked from opening from the inside.
cushion. Refer to the heading below, Low- For more information, see page 58.
ering the two-stage booster cushion.
ISOFIX fixture system for child seats
Lowering the two-stage booster cushion
Lowering can take place from both the upper
and lower stage to fully lowered position in the
cushion. However, it is not possible to adjust
the booster cushion from the upper stage to
the lower stage. Press down with your hand in the centre of
the cushion in order to lock it.

WARNING
If the instructions regarding the two-stage

G021064
booster cushion are not followed then this
could cause serious injury to a child in the
event of an accident. Mounting points for the ISOFIX fixture system
are concealed behind the lower section of the
IMPORTANT rear seat backrest, in the outer seats.
Check that there are no loose objects (e.g. The location of the mounting points is indicated
toys) left behind in the space under the by symbols in the backrest upholstery (see pre-
cushion before lowering. ceding illustration).
Pull the handle forwards to release the
Press the seat cushion down to access the
cushion.
NOTE mounting points.
The booster cushion must be lowered first
when lowering the backrest.

``

37
01 Safety

01 Child safety

NOTE Size Description NOTE


The ISOFIX fixture system is an accessory class If an ISOFIX child seat has no size classifi-
for the passenger seat. cation then the car model must be included
B1 Reduced size (alt.2), front- on the child seat's vehicle list.
facing child seat
Always follow the manufacturer's installation
instructions when connecting a child seat to C Full size, rear-facing child NOTE
the ISOFIX mounting points. seat
Volvo recommends that you contact an
Size classes D Reduced size, rear-facing authorised Volvo dealer for recommenda-
Child seats are in different sizes – cars are in child seat tions about which ISOFIX child seats Volvo
recommends.
different sizes. This means that not all child
E Rear-facing infant seat
seats are suitable for all seats in all car models.
Consequently, a size classification has been F Transverse infant seat, left-
introduced for child seats using the ISOFIX fix- hand
ture system in order to assist users in choosing
G Transverse infant seat, right-
the correct child seat (see the following table).
hand

Size Description
class WARNING
Never place a child in the passenger seat if
A Full size, front-facing child the car is equipped with an activated airbag.
seat

B Reduced size (alt. 1), front-


facing child seat

38
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Types of ISOFIX child seat


Type of child seat Weight (Age) Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIX installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Infant seat transverse max. 10 kg (0-9 months) F - -

G - -

Infant seat, rear-facing max. 10 kg (0-9 months) E OK OK

Infant seat, rear-facing max. 13 kg (0 – 12 months) E OK OK

D OK OK

C OK OK

Child seat, rear-facing 9 – 18 kg (9 – 36 months) D OK OK

C OK OK

Front-facing child seat 9 – 18 kg (9 – 36 months) B OKA OKA

B1 OKA OKA

A OKA OKA
A Volvo recommends rear-facing child seats for this group.

``

39
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Upper mounting points for child seats NOTE


For cars equipped with a cargo area cover
over the cargo area, this must be removed
before a child seat can be fitted in the
mounting points.

For detailed information on how the child seat


should be tensioned in the upper mounting
points, see the seat manufacturer's instruc-
tions.

G017676
WARNING
The child seat's straps must always be
The car is equipped with upper mounting routed under the rear head restraints before
points for certain front-facing child seats. being tensioned at the mounting point.
These mounting points are located on the rear
of the seat.
The upper mounting points are primarily
intended for use with front-facing child seats.
Volvo recommends that small children should
sit in rear-facing child seats to as late an age
as possible.

NOTE
For cars with folding head restraints on the
outside seats the head restraints should be
folded to facilitate the installation of this
type of child seat.

40
01 Safety

01

41
Remote control key/key blade................................................................ 44
Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*...................................... 49
Keyless drive*.......................................................................................... 51
Locking/unlocking................................................................................... 53
Child safety locks.................................................................................... 58
Alarm*...................................................................................................... 59

42 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


LOCKS AND ALARM

02
02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

General The key blade's unique code is provided by Indicator for locking/unlocking
The car is supplied with two remote control authorised Volvo workshops, which are rec- When the car is locked or unlocked using the
02 ommended when ordering new key blades. remote control key, the direction indicators
keys or two PCCs (Personal Car
Communicator). They are used to start the car confirm that locking/unlocking was correctly
Loss of a remote control key performed:
and for locking and unlocking.
If you lose a remote control key then new ones
More remote control keys can be ordered – up can be ordered at a workshop - an authorised • Locking - one flash
to six can be programmed and used for the Volvo workshop is recommended. The remain- • Unlocking - two flashes.
same car. ing remote control keys must then be taken to After locking the indication is only given if all
The PCC has increased functionality com- the workshop. The code of the missing remote locks are activated once the doors have been
pared with the remote control key. The contin- control key must be erased from the system as closed.
uation of this chapter describes the functions a theft prevention measure.
The function can be activated/deactivated
available in both the PCC and the remote con- The current number of keys registered to the under Car settings Light settings Lock
trol key. car can be checked under Car settings Car
confirmation light and Car settings Light
Key memory Number of keys. For a
WARNING settings Unlock confirmation light.
description of the menu system, see
If there are children in the car: page 120. For a description of the menu system, see
page 120.
Always remember to switch off the power Key memory – door mirrors and driver's
supply to power windows and sunroof by Immobiliser
removing the remote control key if the driver seat
leaves the car. The settings are automatically connected to Each remote control key has a unique code.
each respective remote control key, see pages The car can only be started with the correct
76 and 94. remote control key with the correct code.
Detachable key blade
A remote control key includes a detachable The function can be activated/deactivated The following error messages in the combined
metal key blade for mechanical locking/ under Car settings Car Key memory instrument panel's information display are rela-
unlocking of the driver's door and glovebox. Seat & mirror positions. For a description of ted to the electronic immobiliser:
the menu system, see page 120.
The key blade is also used to deactivate/acti-
vate PACOS*, see page 22. For cars with Keyless drive function, see
page 51.
For key blade functions, see page 47.

44 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

Message Specification Functions

Key error Try again Error reading remote 02


control key during
start. Try to start the
car again.

Car key not found Applies only to the


PCC's Keyless drive
function. Errors

G021079
reading the PCC
during starting. Try

G021078
to start the car PCC* (Personal Car Communicator).
again.
Remote control key. Information
Immobiliser Try Remote control key Locking
start again function error during Function buttons
start. If the fault per- Unlocking Locking – Locks the doors and tailgate
sists the recommen- Approach light duration and then activates the alarm.
dation is to contact
an authorised Volvo Tailgate Press and hold (at least 4 seconds) to close all
workshop. the windows and sunroof* simultaneously.
Panic function
WARNING
For starting the car, see page 100.
If the sunroof and windows are closed using
the remote control key, check that no one is
in danger of getting hands caught.

Unlocking – Unlocks the doors and tail-


gate while the alarm is deactivated.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 45


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

The function can be changed from unlocking Range Using the information button
all doors simultaneously, to opening the driv- The remote control key has a range of up to ± Press the information button .
02 er's door after one press of the button and, 20 m from the car.
> All indicator lamps flash for approxi-
after a further press of the button - within
mately 7 seconds and the light travels
10 seconds - opening the remaining doors. NOTE around on the PCC. This indicates that
The function is changed under Car settings The remote control key functions can be information from the car has been read.
Lock settings Doors unlock. For a disrupted by surrounding radio waves, If any of the other buttons are pressed
description of the menu system, see buildings, topographical conditions etc. The
car can always be locked/unlocked using during this time then the reading is inter-
page 120. rupted.
the key blade, see page 48.
Approach lighting – Used to switch on the
car's lighting at a distance. For more informa- NOTE
tion, see page 85. Unique functions PCC* If none of the indicator lamps illuminates
Tailgate - Unlocks and disarms the alarm with repeated use of the information button
and in different locations (as well as after 7
for the tailgate only. On cars with power tail- seconds and after the light has travelled
gate* the tailgate is opened after the button is around on the PCC), contact a workshop -
kept depressed. For more information, see an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
page 55. mended.
Panic function – Used to attract attention
in an emergency. Indicator lamps display information in accord-
ance with the following illustration:
Press and hold the red button for at least 3 sec-

G021080
onds or press it twice within 3 seconds to acti-
vate the direction indicators and the horn.
The function can be turned off with the same Information button
button once it has been active for at least
5 seconds. Otherwise the function switches off Indicator lamps
automatically after 2 minutes and 45 seconds. Using the information button enables access to
certain information from the car via the indica-
tor lamps.

46 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

have a range of up to a maximum of 100 m from whether anybody is in the car. This indication
the car. is only displayed if the alarm was triggered.
02
The HBS detects an individual's heartbeat that
NOTE is transmitted to the car's bodywork. For this
The information button functions can be reason the function of the HBS can be distur-
disrupted by surrounding radio waves, bed in an environment subject to noise and
buildings, topographical conditions etc. vibration.

Out of PCC range Detachable key blade

G030262
If the PCC is too far away from the car for the Using the remote control key's detachable key
information to be read then the status the car blade:
was last left in is shown, without the light trav-
Green continuous light – the car is locked. elling around on the PCC. • the driver's door can be opened manually
if central locking cannot be activated with
Yellow continuous light – the car is If several PCCs are used for the car then it is the remote control key
unlocked. only the PCC last used for locking/unlocking
that shows correct status.
• access to the glovebox is blocked
Red light flashing alternately in the two
indicator lamps – indicates, using the HBS • PACOS* activated/deactivated, see
page 22.
(Heart Beat Sensor) that someone may be NOTE
in the car. This indication is only displayed
If no indicator lamps illuminate when the
if the alarm was triggered. information button is used then this can be
Red continuous light – the alarm has been because the last communication between
triggered. the PCC and the car was disrupted by sur-
rounding radio waves, buildings, topo-
Range graphical conditions etc.
The PCC lock functions have a range of up to
20 m from the car. Heart Beat Sensor
The approach lighting, panic function and the The function operates using an HBS (Heart
functions controlled by the information button Beat Sensor). HBS is a supplement to the car's
alarm system and can indicate at a distance

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 47


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

Removing the key blade Unlocking doors with the key blade
If central locking cannot be activated with the
02
remote control key, e.g. if the batteries are dis-
charged, then the driver's door can be opened
as follows:

NOTE
When the driver's door is unlocked using the
key blade and is opened, the alarm is trig-
gered.

G021082
1. Unlock the driver's door using the key
blade in the door handle's keyhole.
Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side.
2. Deactivate the alarm by inserting the
At the same time pull the key blade straight remote control key in the ignition switch.
out backwards.

Inserting the key blade


Carefully refit the key blade in place in the
remote control key, to avoid damaging it.
1. Hold the remote control key with the slot
pointed up and lower the key blade into its
slot.
2. Lightly press the key blade. You should
hear a "click" when the key blade is locked
in.

48
02 Locks and alarm

Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*

Replacing the battery Battery replacement


The batteries should be replaced if: Closely study how the battery/batteries are
secured on the inside of the cover, with 02
• the information symbol is illuminated and
regard to their (+) and (–) sides.
the display shows Replace car key
battery Remove control key (1 battery)
and/or 1. Carefully prize out the battery.
2. Install a new one with the (+) side down.
• the locks repeatedly do not react to signals
from the remote control key within PCC* (2 batteries)
20 metres from the car. 1. Carefully prize out the batteries.
Opening
2. First install one new one with the (+) side
Slide the spring-loaded catch to the up.
side.
3. Position the white plastic tab in between
At the same time pull the key blade and finally install a second new battery with
straight out backwards. the (+) side down.

Insert a 3 mm slot screwdriver in the Battery type


hole behind the spring-loaded catch and Use batteries with the designation CR2430, 3V
gently prize the remote control key up. - one in the remote control key and two in the
PCC.
NOTE
Assembly
Turn the remote control key over with the 1. Press the remote control key together.
buttons facing up, this is to avoid the bat-
teries falling out when it is opened. 2. Hold the remote control key with the slot
pointed up and lower the key blade into its
slot.
IMPORTANT
3. Lightly press the key blade. You should
Avoid touching the battery and its terminals hear a "click" when the key blade is locked
with your fingers, as this could damage their in.
functionality.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 49


02 Locks and alarm

Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*

IMPORTANT
02 Make sure that you dispose of old batteries
in an environmentally-friendly way.

50 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

Keyless drive (only PCC) possible to lock or unlock a door if the PCC is Interference to PCC function
on the opposite side of the car. Electromagnetic fields and screening can inter-
Keyless lock and ignition system fere with the keyless drive system. For this rea- 02
The red rings in the preceding illustration indi-
cate the range covered by the system's anten- son, do not place the PCC near mobile phones
nas. or metallic objects.

If all PCCs are removed from the car when the If interference is experienced nonetheless, use
engine is running or key position II is active the PCC and key blade in the normal way, see
(see page 73) and if all doors are closed, then page 45.
a warning message is shown in the information Unlocking
display and an audio reminder signal sounds at Open the doors with the door handles or open
the same time. the tailgate with the tailgate's handle.
The warning message clears and the audio
Unlocking with the key blade
reminder signal stops when the PCC is brought
If the keyless drive function in the PCC is not
back to the car after:
operating, then the driver's door can be
The keyless drive function in the PCC allows • a door has been opened and closed unlocked with the key blade. In this case cen-
the car to be unlocked, driven and locked with- tral locking is not activated.
out the need for a key. You simply have to have • the PCC is inserted into the ignition switch
the PCC with you. The system makes it easier • the READ button has been pressed.
and more convenient to open the car, e.g.
NOTE
Handling the PCC safely
when your hands are full. If a PCC with keyless drive function is left in the Unlocking with the key blade triggers the
car, it is deactivated temporarily when the car alarm. For deactivation, see page 60.
The car's two PCCs incorporate the Keyless
function. Additional PCCs can be ordered. is locked. This prevents unauthorised entry.
However, if someone breaks into the car, Key memory – driver's seat and door
PCC range mirrors
In order to open a door or the tailgate, a PCC opens the door and finds the PCC, it can be
must be no more than approx. 1.5 metres from reactivated. It is therefore important to handle PCC memory function
the car door handle or tailgate. This means that all PCCs with great care. If several people each with a PCC approach the
the person who wishes to lock or unlock a door car, then the settings for seat and mirrors are
must have the PCC with him or her. It is not IMPORTANT implemented for the person who opens the
driver's door.
Never leave a PCC behind in the car.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 51


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

After the driver's door has been opened by Lock settings Door handle, right rear
person A with PCC A, but person B with PCC The keyless function can be adapted to specify
02 B shall drive, the settings can be changed in Centre console, under the rear section
which of the car doors are to be unlocked,
three ways: under Car settings Lock settings Centre console, under the front section.
• Standing by the driver's door, or sitting Keyless entry. For a description of the menu
behind the steering wheel, person B system, see page 120.
WARNING
presses their PCC's unlock button, see
page 45. People with pacemaker operations should
Antenna location not come closer than 22 cm to the keyless
• Select one of three possible memories for system's antennae with their pacemaker.
seat adjustment with seat button 1-3, see This is to prevent interference between the
page 76. pacemaker and the keyless system.
• Adjust seat and mirrors manually, see
page 75 and 94.

Locking
Lock the doors and the tailgate by pressing the
lock button on one of the door handles on the
outside.

G021179
All doors and the tailgate must be closed
before the car can be locked. Otherwise the car
will not be locked.
The keyless system has a number of integrated
antennae located around the car:
NOTE
Tailgate, by wiper motor
On cars with automatic transmission, the
gear selector must be set in the P position Door handle, left rear
– otherwise the car cannot be locked or the
alarm armed. Roof, above centre rear seat
Cargo area, central and furthest in under
the floor

52 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

From the outside From the inside Locking


The remote control key can lock/unlock all Press the central locking button after the
02
doors and the tailgate simultaneously. Different front doors have been closed. Press and hold
sequences can be selected for locking/unlock- (at least 4 seconds) to also close all the side
ing; see page 120. windows and the sunroof* simultaneously.
The lock buttons and door handles are disen- All the doors can be locked manually with their
gaged during locking which also prevents respective lock buttons after the door has been
opening from the inside, so-called deadlocks closed.
function*, see page 56.
Global opening
If it is not possible to lock/unlock with the
Press and hold the central locking button
remote control key, the battery may be dis-
(at least 4 seconds) to also open all the win-
charged - lock or unlock the door with the
dows simultaneously - for example, to quickly
detachable key blade; see page 48.
All of the doors and the tailgate can be locked ventilate the passenger compartment during
WARNING or unlocked simultaneously using the central hot weather.
Be aware that there is a risk that you can be locking button on either front door. Press one
Automatic locking
locked in the car if it is locked from the out- side of the button to lock - the other side
The doors and tailgate are locked automati-
side. to unlock. cally when the car starts to move.
Unlocking The function can be activated/deactivated
Automatic relocking
A door can be unlocked from the inside in two under Car settings Lock settings
If none of the doors or the tailgate is opened
different ways: Doors automatic lock. (For a description of
within 2 minutes of unlocking, all are locked
the menu system, see page 120.)
again automatically. This function reduces the • Press the central locking button .
risk that the car is left unlocked unintentionally.
Press and hold (at least 4 seconds) to also
(For cars with alarm, see page 59.)
open all the side windows* simultaneously.
• Pull the door handle once and release - the
door is unlocked. Pull the door handle
again to open the door.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 53


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

Glovebox Tailgate The doors remain locked and armed.

02
NOTE
When the tailgate is closed it remains
unlocked until the car is relocked with the
remote control key's lock button.

Unlocking the car from inside

The glovebox can only be locked/unlocked Unlocking with the remote control key
using the remote control key's detachable key The alarm for the tailgate can be disarmed*,
blade. (For information on the key blade, see and the tailgate unlocked and opened on its
page 48). own* by using the remote control key.
Locking the glovebox:
Insert the key blade in the glovebox lock. NOTE
On cars with the power operated tailgate
Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise. option, the tailgate is opened – otherwise it To unlock and open* the tailgate.
The keyhole is horizontal in the locked is only unlocked. ± Press the lighting panel button (1).
position.
Pull out the key blade. If the car is equipped with an alarm* the alarm Locking with the remote control key
indicator on the instrument panel stops to Press the remote control key button for lock-
Unlock by carrying this out in reverse order. show that alarm for the whole of the car is not ing, see page 45.
armed. The alarm's level and movement sen- If the car is equipped with an alarm* the alarm
sors and the sensors for opening the tailgate indicator on the instrument panel starts to
are automatically disconnected. flash, which means that the alarm is armed.

54 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

Power operated tailgate* NOTE WARNING


• If the system has been operating con- Pay attention to the risk of crushing when 02
tinuously for more than 60 seconds then opening/closing. Before starting to open/
it is switched off to avoid overloading. It close; make sure that there is nobody close
can be used again after about 10 to the tailgate as a crushing injury could
minutes. have serious consequences.

• If the battery has been discharged or Always operate the tailgate with caution.
disconnected then the cover must be
opened and closed manually once in Manual tailgate operation
order to reset the system. The system is disengaged if the rubberised

G031965
pressure plate beneath the outside handle is
Snow and wind actuated a second time. The tailgate can then
If the tailgate is forced down by something just be operated manually.
when it is being opened, e.g. snow, ice or
IMPORTANT Opening the tailgate
strong wind, and this causes the tailgate to
Pay attention to the height of the roof when lower, then it is closed automatically. The tailgate can be opened three
using power operation. Do not use power ways (two of which involve this but-
tailgate operation with low roof heights, see Pinch protection ton):
under the heading "Interrupt opening/clos- If something with sufficient resistance prevents
ing the tailgate". • Long press on the tailgate button in the
the tailgate from opening/closing then the lighting panel - hold the button depressed
pinch protection is activated. until the tailgate starts to open.
• During opening - power tailgate operation • Long press on the remote control button
is deactivated and the tailgate is disen- for the tailgate - hold the button depressed
gaged. until the tailgate starts to open.
• During closing - the tailgate returns to the • Lightly press the rubberised pressure plate
fully open position. beneath the outside handle and raise the
tailgate.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 55


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

Closing the tailgate Deadlocks* If someone is going to stay in the car but the
Close using this button on the tailgate When deadlocked, the doors cannot be doors must be locked from the outside, then
02 or manually. the deadlocks function can be temporarily
opened from the inside if they are locked.
switched off. This is carried out as follows:
• Press the tailgate's button – the tailgate The deadlocks are activated with the remote
closes automatically. control key and are set after a 10 second delay 1. Access the menu system under Car
after the doors are locked. settings (for a detailed description of the
Stop the opening/closing of the tailgate menu system, see page 120).
This can be done four ways (of which The car can only be unlocked from a deadlock
three involve this button): state with the remote control key. The driver's 2. Select Reduced guard.
door can also be unlocked with the detachable 3. Select Activate once.
• Press the tailgate button in the lighting
key blade.
panel > The instrument panel display shows the
• Press the tailgate button on the remote Temporary deactivation message Reduced guard See
control manual and the deadlocks function is
switched off when the car is locked.
• Press the tailgate button on the tailgate
• Press the rubberised pressure plate or
beneath the outside handle. ± Select Ask on exit.
Tailgate movement is stopped following the > Each time the engine is switched off the
same pattern as when pinch protection is trig- audio system's display shows the mes-
gered. Refer to this chapter's section with the sage ENTER reduces protection until
heading "Pinch protection". the engine is started again. Press
EXIT to cancel - then select one of the

G031384
alternatives.
If the deadlocks function shall be switched
Active menu options are indicated with a cross. off
Navigation
± Press ENTER and lock the car. (If the car
ENTER is equipped with an alarm with movement
and tilt detectors* then these are switched
MENU off at the same time, see page 60.)
EXIT

56 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

> The next time the engine is started, the


system is reset to zero and the instru-
ment panel display shows the message 02
Full guard at which the deadlocks func-
tion and the alarm's movement and tilt
detectors are re-engaged.
If the locking system shall not be changed
± Select no options at all and lock the car.
or

± Press EXIT and lock the car.

NOTE
If the car is equipped with an alarm:
• Remember that the car's alarm is armed
when the car is locked.
• If any of the doors are opened from the
inside then the alarm will be triggered.

WARNING
Do not allow anyone to remain in the car
without first deactivating the deadlocks to
avoid the risk of anyone being locked in.

57
02 Locks and alarm

Child safety locks

Manual blocking of the rear doors Electrical locking of the rear doors and
power windows*
02

G021077

G019300
The child safety locks are located on the trailing
edge of the rear doors and are only accessible When the electric child safety lock is active:
when the doors are open.
• the rear windows can only be opened with
± Use the key blade to turn the lock and thus the driver's door control panel
activate or deactivate the child safety lock. • the rear doors cannot be opened from the
The door cannot be opened from inside. inside.
1. Child safety locks are activated/deacti-
The doors can be opened from inside.
vated in ignition position I or II see
page 73.
NOTE 2. Press the button in the driver's door control
Cars with electric child safety locks do not panel.
have manual child locks. > The information display shows a mes-
sage.
The lamp on the switch illuminates when
the locks are activated.

58 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Alarm*

General NOTE Alarm indicator


The alarm is triggered if:
The movement detectors trigger the alarm 02
• a door, the bonnet or the tailgate is opened in the event of movements in the passenger
compartment. For this reason the alarm
• a non-approved remote control key is used
could be triggered if the car is left with a
or if an attempt is made to force the ignition window open or if an electric passenger
switch compartment heater is used.
• a movement is detected in the passenger To avoid this: Close the windows when leav-
compartment (if fitted with a movement ing the car and aim the air from the passen-
detector*) ger compartment heater so that it is not
• the car is raised or towed away (if fitted directed up into the passenger compart-
with a tilt detector*) ment.
• the battery's cable is disconnected
• anyone tries to disconnect the siren. NOTE A red LED on the instrument panel indicates
If there is a fault in the alarm system, the infor- One of the detectors for the alarm is located the alarm system's status:
mation display shows a message. In which under the cup holder in the centre console. • LED not lit – Alarm not armed
case, contact a workshop - an authorised This detector is sensitive for metals.
• The LED flashes once every other second
Volvo workshop is recommended. Avoid storing coins, keys or similar metal – Alarm is armed
objects in the centre console's cup holder
as such objects could accidentally trigger • The LED flashes rapidly after disarming the
the alarm. alarm (and until the remote control key is
inserted in the ignition switch and key posi-
tion I is selected) – Alarm has been trig-
NOTE gered.
Do not attempt to repair or modify alarm Arming the alarm
system components. All such attempts
could affect the terms of insurance. ± Press the remote control key lock button.

Disarming the alarm


± Press the remote control key unlock but-
ton.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 59


02 Locks and alarm

Alarm*

Deactivating a triggered alarm > The alarm is triggered and the siren during a ferry crossing - the movement and tilt
± Press the remote control key unlock button sounds. detectors can be temporarily switched off. This
02 or insert the remote control key in the igni- is carried out as follows:
2. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
tion switch. switch. 1. Access the menu system under Car
> The alarm is deactivated. The alarm settings (for a detailed description of the
Other alarm functions indicator flashes quickly until the remote menu system, see page 120).
control key is inserted. 2. Select Reduced guard.
Automatic re-arming of the alarm
This function prevents the car being left with 3. Select Activate once:
alarm disarmed unintentionally. Reduced alarm level
> The instrument panel display shows the
If the car is unlocked with the remote control message Reduced guard See
key (and the alarm is disarmed) but none of the manual and the movement and tilt
doors or the tailgate is opened within detectors are switched off when the car
2 minutes, then the alarm is automatically re- is locked.
armed. The car is relocked at the same time.
or
Alarm signals ± Select Ask on exit.
When the alarm is triggered, the following hap- > Each time the engine is switched off the
pens: audio system's display shows the mes-
• A siren sounds for less than 30 seconds. sage ENTER to reduce guard until

G031384
The siren has its own battery which works the car has been started. Press EXIT
independently of the car battery. to cancel. - then select one of the alter-
Active menu options are indicated with a cross.
• The direction indicators flash for 5 minutes natives.
Navigation
or until the alarm has been deactivated. If the movement and tilt detectors shall be
ENTER switched off:
Remote control key not working
If the remote control key is not working, the MENU ± Press ENTER and lock the car. (If the car
alarm can still be switched off and the car is equipped with the deadlocks function*
started as follows: EXIT then it is switched off at the same time, see
To avoid inadvertently triggering of the alarm - page 56.)
1. Open the driver's door with the key blade.
for example when leaving a dog in the car or

60 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Alarm*

> The next time the engine is started, the


system is reset to zero and the instru-
ment panel display shows the message 02
Full guard at which the movement and
tilt detectors and the deadlocks function
are re-engaged.
If the detectors shall not be switched off:
± Select no options at all and lock the car.
or

± Press EXIT and lock the car.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 61


Instruments and controls........................................................................ 64
Key positions.......................................................................................... 73
Seats....................................................................................................... 75
Steering wheel........................................................................................ 79
Lighting................................................................................................... 80
Wipers and washing................................................................................ 89
Windows, rearview and door mirrors...................................................... 92
Compass*................................................................................................ 97
Power panorama roof* ........................................................................... 98
Starting the engine................................................................................ 100
Starting the engine – external battery................................................... 102
Gearboxes............................................................................................. 103
All-wheel drive – AWD*......................................................................... 107
Foot brake............................................................................................. 108
Hill Descent Control (HDC)................................................................... 110
Parking brake........................................................................................ 112

G020912
HomeLinkŸ *.......................................................................................... 115

62 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


YOUR DRIVING ENVIRONMENT

03
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

03

Left-hand drive.

64
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Function Page Function Page


Menus and messages, 80, Climate control, ECC 128
direction indicators, 83, 123,
main/dipped beam, trip 150 Gear selector 103
computer
Controls for active chas- 154 03
Cruise control 155, 156 sis (Four-C)*

Horn, airbags 20, 79 Wipers and washing 89, 90

Combined instrument 67, 71 Steering wheel adjust- 79


panel ment

Menu, audio and phone 120, Bonnet opener 228


control 137, 194
Parking brake* 112
Start/stop button 100
Seat adjustment* 75
Ignition switch 73
Headlamp control, 54, 80,
Information display for 120 opener for fuel filler flap 208
menu navigation and tailgate
Door handle -

Control panel 53, 58,


92, 94

Hazard warning flashers 83

Menu control and audio 120, 138


system

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 65


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

03

Right-hand drive.

66
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Function Page Function Page Information displays

Information display for 120 Bonnet opener 228


menu navigation
Steering wheel adjust- 79
Ignition switch 73 ment
03
Start/stop button 100 Menus and messages, 80,
direction indicators, 83, 123,
Cruise control 155, 156 main/dipped beam, trip 150
computer
Combined instrument 67, 71
panel Controls for active chas- 154
sis (Four-C)*
Horn, airbags 20, 79 Information displays.
Gear selector 103
Menu, audio and phone 120, The information displays show information on
control 137, 194 Climate control, ECC 128 some of the car's functions, e.g. cruise control,
trip computer and messages. The information
Wipers and washing 89, 90 Menu control and audio 120, 138 is shown with text and symbols.
system There are further descriptions under the func-
Headlamp control, 54, 80,
Hazard warning flashers 83 tions that use the information displays.
opener for fuel filler flap 208
and tailgate

Door handle -

Control panel 53, 58,


92, 94

Seat adjustment* 75

Parking brake 112

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 67


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Meters Indicator, information and warning symbols go out after 5 seconds except the
symbols symbol for faults in the car's emissions system
and the symbol for low oil pressure.

Indicator and information symbols


Symbol Specification
03
ABL fault

Emissions system

ABS fault

Meters in the combined instrument panel.


Rear fog lamp on
Speedometer Indicator and warning symbols.
Main beam and direction indicator symbol
Fuel gauge. See also Trip computer, page Stability system
150, and Refuelling, page 208. Indicator and information symbols
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine Indicator and warning symbols1 Engine preheater (diesel)
speed in thousands of revolutions per
minute (rpm). Functionality check Low level in fuel tank
All indicator and warning symbols illuminate in
key position II or when the engine is started. Information, read display text
When the engine has started, all the symbols
should go out except the parking brake sym-
bol, which only goes out when the brake is dis- Main beam On
engaged.
If the engine does not start or if the functionality
check is carried out in key position II then all

1 For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warnings are made via display text. For information on checking the oil level, see page 229.

68
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Symbol Specification Rear fog lamp NOTE


This symbol illuminates when the rear fog lamp
Left-hand direction indicators is on. There is only one fog lamp. It is located When a service message is shown, the sym-
bol and message are cleared using the
on the driver's side. READ button, or clear automatically after a
Right-hand direction indicators Stability system while.
A flashing symbol indicates that the stability
system is operating. If the symbol illuminates 03
Main beam On
ABL fault with constant glow then there is a fault in the The symbol illuminates when main beam is on
The symbol illuminates if a fault has arisen in system. and with main beam flash
the ABL function (Active Bending Lights).
Engine preheater (diesel)* Left/right-hand direction indicators
Emissions system This symbol illuminates during engine preheat- Both direction indicator symbols flash when
If the symbol illuminates then it may be due to ing. Preheating occurs when the temperature the hazard warning flashers are used.
a fault in the car's emissions system. Drive to is below 2 °C. The car can be started once the
a workshop for checking. Volvo recommends symbol goes out. Indicator and warning symbols
that you seek assistance from an authorised
Low level in fuel tank Symbol Specification
Volvo workshop.
When the symbol illuminates the level in the
ABS fault fuel tank is low, refuel as soon as possible. Low oil pressureA
If this symbol illuminates then the system is not
Information, read display text
working. The car's regular brake system con- Parking brake applied
When one of the car's systems does not
tinues to work, but without the ABS function.
behave as intended, this information symbol
1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the illuminates and a text appears on the informa- Airbags – SRS
engine. tion display. The message text is cleared with
2. Restart the engine. the READ button, see page 123, or it disap- Seatbelt reminder
pears automatically after a time (time depend-
3. If the symbol remains illuminated, drive to ing on which function is indicated). The infor-
a workshop to have the ABS system mation symbol can also illuminate in conjunc- Alternator not charging
checked. Volvo recommends that you tion with other symbols.
seek assistance from an authorised Volvo
workshop.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 69


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Symbol Specification NOTE If the brake and ABS symbols illuminate at the
same time, there may be a fault in the brake
Fault in brake system This symbol also illuminates when the force distribution system.
mechanical parking brake is only lightly
applied. 1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
Warning engine.

03 Airbags – SRS 2. Restart the engine.


A For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure If this symbol remains illuminated or illuminates
is not used. Warnings are made via display text, see pages
229 and 230. while driving, it means a fault has been
• If both symbols extinguish, continue
driving.
detected in the seatbelt buckle, SRS, SIPS, or
Low oil pressure IC systems. Drive immediately to a workshop • If the symbols remain illuminated, check
If this symbol illuminates during driving then to have the system checked. Volvo recom- the level in the brake fluid reservoir, see
the engine's oil pressure is too low. Stop the page 232. If the brake fluid level is nor-
mends that you seek assistance from an
engine immediately and check the engine oil mal but the symbols are still illuminated,
authorised Volvo workshop.
level, top up if necessary. If the symbol illumi- the car can be driven, with great care, to
nates and the oil level is normal, contact a
Seatbelt reminder a workshop to have the brake system
This symbol illuminates if someone in a front checked. Volvo recommends that you
workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek
seat has not put on their seatbelt or if someone seek assistance from an authorised
assistance from an authorised Volvo work-
in a rear seat has taken off their seatbelt. Volvo workshop.
shop.
Parking brake applied Alternator not charging
This symbol illuminates during driving if a fault WARNING
This symbol illuminates with a constant glow
has occurred in the electrical system. Visit a If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the
when the parking brake is applied. With the
workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
electric parking brake, this symbol flashes
assistance from an authorised Volvo work- before topping up the brake fluid.
while it is being applied and then illuminates
shop. The loss of brake fluid must be investigated
with a constant glow.
Fault in brake system by a workshop. Volvo recommends that you
A flashing symbol means that a fault has arisen. contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
If this symbol illuminates, the brake fluid level
Read the message on the information display.
may be too low. Stop the car in a safe place
and check the level in the brake fluid reservoir,
see page 232.

70
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

WARNING atory text message in the combined instrument Display for trip meter
panel. Stop the car in a safe place as soon as
If the brake and ABS symbols are illumi- possible and close the door, bonnet or boot lid, Controls for switching between trip meters
nated at the same time, there is a risk that whichever is open. T1 and T2, as well as resetting the trip
the rear end will skid during heavy braking. meters.
If the car is driven at a speed lower than
The meters are used to measure short dis-
approx. 7 km/h then the information
Warning tances. 03
symbol illuminates.
The red warning symbol illuminates when a
One short press on the control switches
fault has been indicated which could affect the If the car is driven at a speed higher
between the two trip meters T1 and T2. A long
safety and/or driveability of the car. An explan- than approx. 7 km/h then the warning
press (more than 2 seconds) resets an active
atory text is shown on the information display symbol illuminates.
trip meter to zero. The distance is shown in the
at the same time. The symbol remains visible
display.
until the fault has been rectified but the text Trip meter
message can be cleared with the READ but-
ton, see page 123. The warning symbol can
also illuminate in conjunction with other sym-
bols.
Action:
1. Stop in a safe place. Do not drive the car
further.
2. Read the information on the information
display. Implement the action in accord-
ance with the message in the display. Clear
the message using the READ button.
Reminder – doors not closed Trip meter and controls.
If one of the doors, the bonnet2 or tailgate is not
closed properly then the information or warn-
ing symbol illuminates together with an explan-

2 Only cars with alarm*.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 71


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Clock

03

Clock and setting knob.


Controls for setting the clock.
Information display for showing the time.
Turn the knob clockwise/anticlockwise to set
the time. The set time is shown in the informa-
tion display.
The clock can be temporarily replaced by a
symbol in conjunction with a message, see
page 123.

72
03 Your driving environment

Key positions

Insert and remove the remote control IMPORTANT Key position I


key With the remote control key inserted into the
Foreign objects in the ignition switch may ignition switch - Briefly press on START/STOP
jeopardise the function or destroy the lock.
ENGINE.
Do not press the remote control key incor-
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detach- Key position II
able key blade, see page 48. With the remote control key inserted into the 03
ignition switch - Press on START/STOP
Withdraw the key ENGINE for about 2 seconds.
The remote control key is ejected after a gentle
Back to key position 0
press on it. (Automatic gearbox* must be in
To return to key position 0 from position I or II
position P.)
- Briefly press on START/STOP ENGINE.

Functions
Ignition switch with inserted remote control key. The remote control key's 3 different key posi-
tions can be reached without the need to start
NOTE the engine. The table shows the functions
For cars with keyless function*, see available in each key position.
page 51.
NOTE
Insert the key To reach key position I or II without starting
The remote control key, with its symbols cor- the engine - do not depress the brake/
rectly turned, is fitted in the ignition switch. clutch pedal when the following operations
After a gentle press on the key it is drawn into are carried out.
the lock.
Key position 0
Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch and gently press it - The key is drawn
into the lock.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 73


03 Your driving environment

Key positions

Posi- Function
tion
0 Odometer, clock and tempera-
ture gauge are illuminated. The
steering lock is deactivated. The
03 audio system can be used.

I Panorama roof*, power windows,


12 V socket in the passenger
compartment, RTI*, phone*, ven-
tilation fan, ECC and windscreen
wipers can be used.

II The headlamps come on. Warn-


ing/indicator lamps illuminate for
5 seconds. All equipment oper-
ates apart from heated seats and
rear window defroster, which only
work when the engine is running.

For information on the audio system's func-


tions with remote control key removed, see
page 137.

Starting and stopping the engine


For information about starting/switching off the
engine, see page 100.

Towing
For important information about the remote
control key during towing, see page 224.

74 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Front seats WARNING WARNING


Adjust the position of the driver's seat Check that the front seat backrest is prop-
before setting off, never while driving. erly engaged after it is raised.
Check that the seat is locked in position.
Power seat*
Lowering the front seat backrest* 03

Lumbar support adjustment, turn the


wheel1.
Forward/backward: lift the handle to adjust
the distance to the steering wheel and ped-
als. Check that the seat is locked after Front edge of seat cushion up/down
changing position.
The passenger seat backrest can be folded
Raise/lower* front edge of seat cushion, Seat forward/backward and up/down
forward to make room for long loads.
pump up/down. Backrest rake
Move the seat as far back/down as possi-
Adjust backrest rake, turn the wheel. ble. The power front seats have overload protection
Raise/lower the seat, pump up/down. Adjust the backrest to an upright position. which is tripped if a seat is blocked by an
object. If this happens, go to key position I or
Control panel for power seat*. Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest 0 and wait a short time before adjusting the
and fold it forward. seat again.
Raising takes place in reverse order. Only one movement (forward/back/up/down)
can be made at a time.

1 Also applies to power seat.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 75


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Preparations 2. Hold the button depressed to store set- matically adopt the positions stored in the key
The seats can be adjusted for a certain time tings while depressing one of the memory memory.
after unlocking the door with the remote con- buttons.
trol key without the key in the ignition switch. NOTE
Seat adjustment is normally made in key posi- Using a stored setting
Hold one of the memory buttons depressed The seat and the door mirrors do not move
tion I and can always be made when the engine if they are already set the relevant position.
03 is running. until the seat and the door mirrors stop. If you
release the button then the movement of the
Seat with memory function* seat will stop. It is also possible to use the key memory by
pressing the unlock button on the remote con-
Key memory* in remote control key2 trol key when the driver's door is open.
The positions of the driver's seat and the door
mirrors are stored in the key memory when the The key memory can be activated/deactivated
car is locked with the remote control key. under Car Key memory Seat & mirror
positions. For a description of the menu sys-
tem, see page 120.

NOTE
The key memory in the two remote control
keys and the seat's three memories are
completely independent of each other.

Store setting
Memory button Emergency stop
If the seat accidentally begins to move, press
Memory button one of the buttons to stop the seat.
Memory button Restarting to reach the seat position stored in
When the car is unlocked with the same remote the key memory is performed by pressing the
Button for storing settings control key and the driver's door is opened the unlock button on the remote control key. The
1. Adjust the seat and the door mirrors. driver's seat and also the door mirrors auto- driver's door must then be open.

2 For key memory for keyless drive, see page 51.

76 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

WARNING To lower the head restraint again, the button NOTE


(located in the centre between the backrest
Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do and head restraint, see illustration) must be The front seats may need to be pushed for-
not play with the controls. Check that there pressed in while the head restraint is pressed wards, and/or the backrests adjusted
are no objects in front of, behind or under upwards, in order that the rear backrests
the seat during adjustment. Ensure that down. can be folded forward fully.
none of the backseat passengers will be
trapped. Manual lowering of the outer head 03
restraints, rear seat • The left-hand backrest can be folded sep-
arately.
Heated seats • The centre backrest can be folded sepa-
For heated seats, see page 129. rately.
• The right-hand backrest can be folded
Rear seats together with the centre backrest.
Head restraint, centre seat, rear • All backrests can be folded together.

Pull the locking handle closest to the head


restraint to fold the head restraint forward.
The head restraint is moved back manually
until a "click" can be heard.

Lowering the rear seat backrest


The triple-section rear seat backrest can be
Adjust the head restraint according to passen- folded in different ways in order to facilitate
ger height so that the whole of the back of the loading long objects.
head is covered if possible. Slide it up as
required.

``

77
03 Your driving environment

Seats

WARNING
Check that the backrests and head
restraints in the rear seats are firmly locked
after raising.

03

If the centre backrest is being lowered -


fold and adjust the centre backrest's head
restraint downwards, see page 77.
The outer head restraints are lowered auto-
matically when the outer backrests are
lowered. Pull up the backrest's locking
handle while folding the backrest for-
ward at the same time. A red indicator on
the lock catch shows that the backrest
is no longer locked in place.
Raising takes place in reverse order.

NOTE
When the backrest has been raised, the red
indicator should no longer be showing. If it
is still showing then the backrest is not
locked in place.

78
03 Your driving environment

Steering wheel

Adjusting WARNING Horn


Adjust and secure the steering wheel before
driving.

With speed related power steering* the level of


steering force can be adjusted, see 03
page 154.

Keypads*

G021138
Adjusting the steering wheel. Horn.
Lever - releasing the steering wheel Press the centre of the steering wheel to signal.
Possible steering wheel positions
The steering wheel can be adjusted for both
height and depth:
1. Pull the lever towards you to release the
steering wheel.
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the position Keypads in the steering wheel.
that suits you. Cruise control, see page 155
3. Push back the lever to fix the steering
Adaptive cruise control, see page 156
wheel in place. If the lever is stiff, press the
steering wheel lightly at the same time as Audio and phone control, see page 137
you push the lever back.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 79


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Light switches The display lighting is automatically subdued Main/dipped beam


in darkness - the sensitivity is set with the
thumbwheel.
The intensity of the instrument lighting is
adjusted with the thumbwheel.

03 Headlamp levelling
The load in the car changes the vertical align-
ment of the headlamp beam, which could daz-
zle oncoming motorists. Avoid this by adjusting
the height of the beam. Lower the beam if the

G031407
car is heavily laden.
1. Allow the engine to run or have the remote
Overview, light switches. control key in position I. Headlamp control and stalk switch.
Thumbwheel for adjusting display and Position for main beam flash
2. Roll the thumbwheel up/down to raise/
instrument lighting
lower beam alignment. Position for main beam
Rear fog lamp
Cars with Dual Xenon headlamps* have auto-
Front fog lamps* matic headlamp levelling and therefore do not Posi- Specification
have the thumbwheel. tion
Light switches

Thumbwheel1 for headlamp levelling Automatic*/deactivated dipped


beam. Only main beam flash.
Instrument lighting Position/parking lamps
Different display and instrument lighting is
switched on depending on key position, see
page 73. Automatic dipped beam. Main
beam and main beam flash
work in this position.

1 Not available for cars equipped with Dual Xenon headlamps*.

80 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

NOTE switch towards the steering wheel to the end The function is activated automatically when
position and release. the car is started. In the event of a fault in the
Main beam can only be activated in position function the symbol illuminates in the
. When main beam has been activated the sym-
combined instrument panel at the same time
bol illuminates in the combined instru-
as the information display shows an explana-
ment panel. tory text and a further illuminated symbol.
Main beam flash
Move the stalk switch gently towards the steer- Active Bending Lights (ABL)* 03
ing wheel to the position for main beam flash. Symbol Display Specifica-
Main beam comes on until the stalk switch is tion
released.
Headlamp The system
Dipped beam failure is disen-
When the engine is started, dipped beam is Service gaged. Visit
activated automatically* if the headlamp con- required a workshop
trol is in position 2. If necessary, auto- if the mes-
matic dipped beam for this position can be sage
deactivated by a workshop. Volvo recom- remains.
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo Volvo rec-
workshop. ommends
that you
Headlamp pattern with function deactivated (left)
In position dipped beam is always acti- and activated (right) respectively. contact an
vated automatically when the engine is running authorised
If the car is equipped with active headlamps Volvo work-
or when the remote control key is in position
Active Bending Lights the light from the head- shop.
II.
lamps follows the steering wheel movement in
Main beam order to provide maximum lighting in bends
The function is only active in twilight or dark-
Main beam can only be activated when the and junctions and so provide increased safety.
ness and only when the car is moving.
headlamp control is in position . Acti-
vate/deactivate main beam by moving the stalk

2 For certain markets dipped beam is deactivated in this position.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 81


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

The function3 can be activated/deactivated Brake lights Front fog lamps*


under Car settings Light settings The brake light automatically comes on during
Active bending lights. For a description of the braking.
menu system, see page 120.
Emergency brake lights and automatic
For headlamp pattern adjustment, see hazard warning flashers
page 86. Emergency brake lights (Adaptive Brake
03
Lights) are activated in the event of heavy brak-
Position/parking lamps ing or if the ABS brakes are activated. This
function means that the brake light flashes to
immediately alert cars travelling behind.

G031409
The system is activated if ABS is used for more
than 0.5 seconds or in the event of heavy brak-
ing, however, only when braking from speeds Button for front fog lamps.
above 50 km/h. When the speed of the car is The front fog lamps can be switched on along
lower than 30 km/h the brake lights shine nor- with main/dipped beam or
mally again and the hazard warning flashers position/parking lamps.
are switched on automatically. The hazard
warning flashers remain on until the car accel- Press the button for on/off. The light in the but-
G031408

erates again but can be deactivated with the ton illuminates when the fog lamps are on.
button for hazard warning flashers.
Headlamp control in position for position/parking NOTE
lamps.
Regulations for using front fog lamps vary
Turn the headlamp control to the centre posi- between different countries.
tion (number plate lighting comes on at the
same time).
Rear position lamps also come on when the
tailgate is opened in order to alert anybody
behind.

3 Activated on delivery from the factory.

82 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Rear fog lamp Hazard warning flashers Direction indicators/flashers

03

G031410
Button for rear fog lamp. Button for hazard warning flashers. Direction indicators/flashers.
The rear fog lamp consists of one rear lamp and Press the button to activate the hazard warning Short flash sequence
can only be switched on in combination with flashers. Both direction indicator symbols in Move the stalk switch up or down to the
main/dipped beam or the front fog lamps. the combined instrument panel flash when the first position and release. The direction
hazard warning flashers are in use. indicators flash three times. The function
Press the button for On/Off. The rear fog lamp
indicator symbol on the combined The hazard warning flashers are activated can be activated/deactivated under Car
instrument panel and the light in the button illu- automatically when the car brakes so suddenly settings Light settings Turn
minate when the rear fog lamp is switched on. that the emergency brake lights are activated indicators, 3-flash.
and speed is below 30 km/h. They remain on For a description of the menu sys-
The rear fog lamps are switched off automati- when the car has stopped and are deactivated tem, see page 120.
cally when the engine is switched off. automatically when the car is driven off again
or the button is depressed. Continuous flash sequence
NOTE Move the stalk switch up or down to the
Regulations for using rear fog lamps vary outer position.
between different countries. The stalk switch remains in its position and is
moved back manually, or automatically by the
steering wheel movement.

``

83
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Direction indicator symbols Front roof lighting


For direction indicator symbols, see page 68. The front reading lamps are switched on or off
by pressing the relevant button in the roof con-
sole.
Interior lighting
Rear roof lighting
03

Rear roof lighting in cars with panorama roof.


The lamps are switched on or off by pressing

G021149
each respective button.

G021150
Courtesy lighting
Controls in roof console for the front reading
lamps and passenger compartment lighting. Courtesy lighting (and passenger compart-
Rear roof lighting in cars without panorama roof. ment lighting) is switched on and off respec-
Reading lamp, left-hand side tively when a side door is opened or closed.
Reading lamp, right-hand side
Glovebox lighting
Interior lighting Glovebox lighting is switched on and off
respectively when the lid is opened or closed.
All lighting in the passenger compartment can
be switched on and off manually within Vanity mirror
30 minutes from when: The lighting for the vanity mirror, see
• the engine has been switched off and the page 193, is switched on and off respectively
remote control key is in position 0 when the cover is opened or closed.
• the car has been unlocked but the engine
has not been started.

84
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Lighting, cargo area • the engine is started duration. For a description of the menu sys-
The lighting in the cargo area is switched on • the car is locked. tem, see page 120.
and off respectively when the tailgate is
The passenger compartment lighting comes
opened or closed. Approach light duration*
on and remains on for two minutes if one of the
Automatic lighting doors is open. Approach lighting is switched on with the
The switch for passenger compartment light- If any lighting is switched on manually and the remote control key, see page 45, and is used
03
ing has three positions for the lighting in the car is locked then it will be switched off auto- to switch on the car's lighting at a distance.
passenger compartment: matically after two minutes. When the function is activated with the remote
• Off – right-hand side depressed, automatic control, parking lamps, door mirror lamps,
lighting deactivated. Home safe light duration number plate lighting, interior roof lamps and
courtesy lighting are switched on.
• Neutral position – automatic lighting acti- Some of the exterior lighting can be kept
vated. switched on to work as home safe lighting after The length of time for which the approach light-
• On – left-hand side depressed, passenger the car has been locked. ing should be kept on can be set under Car
compartment lighting on. settings Light settings Approach light
1. Remove the remote control key from the
Neutral position ignition switch. duration. For a description of the menu sys-
When the button is in neutral position the pas- tem, see page 120.
2. Move the left-hand stalk switch toward the
senger compartment lighting is switched on steering wheel to the end position and
and off automatically in accordance with the release it. The function can be activated in
following. the same way as with main beam flash, see
The passenger compartment lighting is page 80.
switched on and remains on for 30 seconds if: 3. Get out of the car and lock the door.
• the car is unlocked with the remote control When the function is activated, dipped beam,
key or key blade, see pages 45 or 48
parking lamps, door mirror lamps, number
• the engine is switched off and the remote plate lighting, interior roof lamps and courtesy
control key is in position 0. lighting are switched on.
Passenger compartment lighting is switched The length of time for which the home safe
off when: lighting should be kept on can be set under Car
settings Light settings Home safe light

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 85


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Adjusting headlamp pattern Active Dual Xenon headlamps* 3. Position the self-adhesive templates at the
The car must be stationary with the engine run- right distance from the edge of the head-
ning when the headlamp pattern is shifted lamp lens using the illustration, see
between right and left-hand traffic. page 87, and the dimensions in the fol-
lowing list:
1. Access the menu system under Car
settings Light settings. • Templates A and D: horizontal line
03 approx. 104 mm, vertical line approx.
2. Select between Temporary RH lights and 20 mm
Temporary LH lights.
• Templates B and C: horizontal line
For a description of the menu system, see approx. 167 mm, vertical line approx.
page 120. 14 mm

G021151
Halogen headlamps
Headlamp pattern, left-hand traffic. The headlamp pattern for halogen headlamps
is readjusted by masking the headlamp lens.
The headlamp pattern may not be as good.
Masking the headlamps
1. Copy the A and B templates for left-hand
drive cars or the C and D templates for
right-hand drive cars with a scale of 1:1,
see page 88:
• A = LHD Right (left-hand drive, right
lens)
G021152

• B = LHD Left (left-hand drive, left lens)


• C = RHD Right (right-hand drive, right
Headlamp pattern, right-hand traffic. lens)
The headlamp pattern must be adjusted to • D = RHD Left (right-hand drive, left lens)
avoid dazzling oncoming motorists and can be 2. Transfer the template to a self-adhesive
set for right or left-hand traffic. The correct pat- waterproof material and cut it out.
tern will also better illuminate the verge.

86 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Aligning the templates

03

Upper row: masking left-hand drive cars, templates A and B. Lower row: masking right-hand drive cars, templates C and D. ``

87
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Templates for halogen headlamps

03

88
03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

Windscreen wipers1 Continuous wiping in the right-hand display in the combined


The wipers sweep at normal speed. instrument panel.
Activating and setting the sensitivity
The wipers sweep at high speed. When activating the rain sensor, the car must
be running or the remote control key in position
I or II while the windscreen wiper stalk switch
must be in position 0 or in the position for a 03
IMPORTANT
single sweep.
Before activating the wipers during winter -
ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen Activate the rain sensor by pressing the button
in and that any snow or ice on the wind- . The windscreen wipers make one
screen (and rear window) is scraped away.
sweep.
Press the stalk switch up for the wipers to make
Windscreen wipers and windscreen washers. IMPORTANT an extra sweep.
Rain sensor, on/off Use plenty of washer fluid when the wipers Turn the thumbwheel upward for higher sensi-
are cleaning the windscreen. The wind-
Thumbwheel sensitivity/frequency screen must be wet when the windscreen tivity and downward for lower sensitivity. (An
wipers are operating. extra sweep is made when the thumbwheel is
Windscreen wipers off turned upward.)
Move the stalk switch to position 0 to Deactivating
Rain sensor*
switch off the windscreen wipers. Deactivate the rain sensor by pressing the but-
The rain sensor automatically starts the wind-
Single sweep screen wipers based on how much water it ton or move the stalk switch down to
Raise the stalk switch and release to detects on the windscreen. The sensitivity of another wiper program.
make one sweep. the rain sensor can be adjusted using the
The rain sensor is automatically deactivated
thumbwheel.
when the key is removed from the ignition
Intermittent wiping
When the rain sensor is activated a light in the switch or five minutes after the ignition has
Set the number of sweeps per time
button the rain sensor symbol is shown been switched off.
unit with the thumbwheel when inter-
mittent wiping is selected.

1 Replacing the wiper blades (see page241) and filling the washer fluid (see page242).
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 89


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

IMPORTANT The windscreen wipers will make several more Wiper and washer, rear window
sweeps once the stalk switch has been
The windscreen wipers could start and be released. The headlamps are washed alter-
damaged in an automatic car wash. Deac- nately to prevent light intensity being reduced.
tivate the rain sensor while the car is running
or the remote control key is in position I or
II. The symbol in the combined instrument NOTE
03 panel and the lamp in the button go out.
One headlamp is washed at a time.

Washing the headlamps and windows Heated washer nozzles*


The washer nozzles are heated automatically
in cold weather to prevent the washer fluid
freezing solid.

High-pressure headlamp washing* Rear window wiper – intermittent wiping


High-pressure headlamp washing consumes a Rear window wiper – continuous speed
large quantity of washer fluid. To save fluid, the
headlamps are washed automatically at every Press the stalk switch forward (see the arrow
fifth windscreen wash cycle. in the illustration above) to initiate rear window
washing and wiping.
Wiper – reversing
Engaging reverse gear while the windscreen
Washing function. wipers are on initiates intermittent rear window
wiping2. The function stops when reverse gear
Washing the windscreen is disengaged.
Move the stalk switch toward the steering
wheel to start the windscreen and headlamp If the rear window wiper is already on at con-
washers. tinuous speed, no change is made.

2 This function (intermittent wiping when reversing) can be deactivated. Visit a workshop. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop.

90 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

NOTE
On cars with rain sensor, the rear window
wiper is activated with reversing, if the sen-
sor is activated and it is raining.

03

91
03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

General Heat-reflecting windscreen* Power windows


Laminated glass
The windscreen and panorama roof
have laminated glass. It is reinforced
which provides better protection
03 against break-ins and improved
sound insulation in the passenger compart-
ment. Other glass surfaces*.

Water and dirt-repellent coating*


Windows are treated with a coating
that improves the view in difficult
weather conditions. Maintenance, see
Areas where IR film is not applied. Driver's door control panel.
page 266.
The windscreen is equipped with a heat- Switch for electric child safety locks* and
IMPORTANT reflecting film (IR) that reduces the solar heat disengaging rear power window buttons,
radiation into the passenger compartment. see page 58.
Do not use a metal ice scraper to remove ice
from the windows. Use the heating to The positioning of electronic equipment, such Rear window controls
remove ice from the door mirrors. as a transponder, behind a glass surface with
Front window controls
heat-reflecting film may affect its function and
performance.
For the optimal function of electronic equip-
WARNING
ment, it should be positioned on the part of the Check that none of the rear seat passengers
windscreen with no heat-reflecting film (see the is in danger of becoming trapped in any way
highlighted area in the previous illustration). when closing the windows from the driver's
door.

92 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

WARNING All power windows can be operated using the Operating with auto
control panel in the driver's door. Each control Move one of the controls up/down to the end
Make sure that children or other passengers panel in the other doors can only control its position and release it. The window runs auto-
are not in danger of becoming trapped in own respective power window. The power win-
any way when closing the windows, in par- matically to its end position.
ticular when the remote control key is used. dows can only be controlled with one control
Remote control and central locking
panel at a time.
buttons
In order that the power windows can be used 03
WARNING All side windows can be opened/closed auto-
the remote control key must be in position I or matically with the remote control key or the
If there are children in the car, remember to II. After the car has been running the power central locking buttons:
always switch off the power supply to the windows can be operated for several minutes
power windows by removing the remote ± Press and hold the lock button until the
even when the remote control key has been
control key if the driver leaves the car. windows start to open/close. To interrupt
removed, but not however after the door has
opening/closing, press the lock button
been opened.
again.
Operating Closing of the windows is stopped and the
window is opened if anything prevents its Resetting
movement. It is possible to force the pinch pro- If the battery is disconnected then the function
tection when closing has been interrupted, e.g. for automatic opening must be reset so that it
with ice, by continuously holding the button up can work correctly.
until the window is closed. The pinch protec- 1. Gently raise the front section of the button
tion is reactivated after a brief pause. to raise the window to its end position and
hold it there for one second.
NOTE
2. Release the button briefly.
One way to reduce the pulsating wind noise
when the rear windows are open is to also 3. Raise the front section of the button again
open the front windows slightly. for one second.
Operating the power windows.
Operating without auto WARNING
Operating without auto
Move one of the controls up/down gently. The Resetting must be carried out to ensure that
Operating with auto power windows move up/down as long as the pinch protection works.
control is held in position.

``

93
03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

Door mirrors Adjusting automatically stop in the fully extended posi-


1. Press the L button for the left-hand door tion.
mirror or the R button for the right-hand
door mirror. The light in the button illumi- Storing the position*
nates. The mirror positions are stored in the key mem-
ory when the car has been locked with the
2. Adjust the position with the joystick in the remote control key. When the car is unlocked
03 centre. with the same remote control key the mirrors
3. Press the L or R button again. The light and the driver's seat adopt the stored positions
should no longer be illuminated. when the driver's door is opened.
The function can be activated/deactivated

G018518
WARNING under Car Key memory Seat & mirror
The mirrors are the wide angle type for opti- positions. For a description of the menu sys-
Door mirror controls. mum surveillance. Objects may appear fur- tem, see page 120.
ther away than they actually are.
Angling the door mirror when parking1
The door mirror can be angled down for the
Retractable power door mirrors* driver to view the side of the road when parking
The mirrors can be retracted for parking/driving for example.
in narrow spaces:
± Engage reverse gear and press the L or R
1. Press down the L and R buttons at the button.
same time.
When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror
2. Release them after automatically returns to its original position
approximately 1 second. The mirrors auto- after about 10 seconds, or earlier by pressing
matically stop in the fully retracted posi- the button labelled L or R respectively
tion.
Automatic retraction when locking
Door mirror controls. Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L When the car is locked/unlocked with the
and R buttons at the same time. The mirrors remote control key the door mirrors are auto-
matically retracted/extended.

1 Only in combination with power seat with memory, see page 75.

94 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

The function can be activated/deactivated Rear window and door mirror Interior rearview mirror
under Car settings Side mirror settings defrosters
Fold mirr. when locking. For a description
of the menu system, see page 120.
Resetting to neutral
Mirrors that have been moved out of position 03
by an external force must be reset electrically
to the neutral position for electric retracting/
extending to work correctly:
1. Retract the mirrors with the L and R but-
tons.
2. Fold them out again with the L and R but-
tons. Control for dimming
3. Repeat the above procedure as necessary. Use the defroster to quickly remove misting
and ice from the rear window and the door mir- Manual dimming
The mirrors are now reset in neutral position. rors. Bright light from behind could be reflected in
the rearview mirror and dazzle the driver. Use
Home safe and approach lighting Press the button once to start simultaneous dimming with the dimming control when lights
The light on the door mirrors illuminates when rear window and door mirror defrosting. The from behind are distracting:
approach lighting or home safe lighting is light in the button indicates that the function is
selected, see page 85. active. Defrosting is deactivated automatically 1. Use dimming by moving the control in
and its duration is controlled by the outside towards the passenger compartment.
temperature. 2. Return to normal position by moving the
The rear window is demisted/defrosted auto- control towards the windscreen.
matically if the car is started in an outside tem-
perature lower than +9 °C.
Automatic dimming*
Bright light from behind is automatically
Automatic defrosting can be selected under dimmed by the rearview mirror. The control is
Climate settings Auto. rear defroster. not available in mirrors with automatic dim-
Select between On or Off. For a description of ming.
the menu system, see page 120.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 95


03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

The compass* can only be specified for rear-


view mirrors with automatic dimming, see
page 97.

03

96 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Compass*

Operation should be calibrated if the car is moved across 4. Hold the button on the underside of the
several magnetic zones. rearview mirror depressed
approx. 3 seconds. The number of the cur-
1. Stop the car in a large open area free from
rent magnetic zone is shown.
steel structures and high-voltage power
lines. 5. Press the button repeatedly until the
required magnetic zone (1–15) is shown.
2. Start the car. 03
See the map of magnetic zones for the
compass.
NOTE
6. Wait until the display resumes showing the
For optimum calibration - switch off all elec-
character C.
trical equipment (climate control system,
wipers etc.) and make sure that all doors are 7. Drive slowly in a circle at a speed of no
closed. more than 10 km/h until a compass direc-
Rearview mirror with compass. tion is shown in the display, indicating that
The upper right-hand corner of the rearview 3. Hold the button on the underside of the calibration is complete. Then drive a further
mirror has an integrated display that shows the rearview mirror depressed 2 circles to fine-tune calibration.
compass direction in which the front of the car approx. 6 seconds (using a paper clip for 8. Repeat the above procedure as necessary.
is pointing. Eight different directions are shown example) until the character C is shown.
with English abbreviations: N (north), NE (north
east), E (east), SE (south east), S (south), SW
(south west), W (west) and NW (north west).
The compass is activated automatically when
the car is started or in ignition position IIsee
page 73. To deactivate/activate the compass -
press in the button on the underside of the mir-
ror using a paper clip for example.

Calibration

G030295
The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones.
The compass is set for the geographic area to
which the car was delivered. The compass Magnetic zones.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 97


03 Your driving environment

Power panorama roof*

General WARNING Closing, manual


The panorama roof is divided into two sections. Closing, automatic
Children, other passengers or objects can
Only the front section can be opened - hori- be trapped by the panorama roof's moving
zontally or vertically at the rear edge (ventilation parts. The panorama roof and curtain can be oper-
position). ated in key position I or II.
• Always operate the panorama roof with
The panorama roof has a sun blind made of caution. Automatic operation
03
perforated fabric and located under the glass 1. To open the curtain all the way - press the
• Do not allow children to play with the
roof to provide extra protection from factors controls. control rearward to the automatic opening
such as strong sunlight. position and release.
• If leaving the car, always take the
remote control key/PCC with you*, and 2. To then open the panorama roof all the way
so prevent the panorama roof from - press the control rearward again to the
being operated. automatic opening position and release.
Close the roof/curtain by repeating the preced-
Operating ing procedure in reverse order - press the con-
trol forward to the automatic closing position
instead.
Rapid opening/closing
The panorama roof and curtain can be opened/
closed simultaneously:
• To open - press the control rearward to the
The panorama roof and curtain are operated automatic operation position twice and
with a control located in the roof. The control release.
is activated when the key is in position I or II, • To close - press the control forward to the
see page 73. automatic operation position twice and
release.

Opening, automatic
Opening, manual

98 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Power panorama roof*

Manual operation Ventilation position Closing using the remote control key or
1. To open the curtain - press the control central locking button
rearward to the point of resistance for man-
ual opening. The curtain moves towards
maximum opening as long as the button is
depressed.
2. To angle the panorama roof - press the 03
control rearward again to the point of resis-
tance for manual opening
3. To open the panorama roof - press the
control rearward to the point of resistance
for manual opening a third time. The pan-
orama roof moves towards maximum Ventilation position, vertically at the rear edge.
opening as long as the button is kept
Open by pressing the rear edge of the con- One long press on the lock button, see pages
depressed.
trol upward. 45 (remote control key) and 53 (central locking
Close the roof/curtain by repeating the preced- Close by pulling the rear edge of the con- button), closes the panorama roof and all the
ing procedure in reverse order - press the con- trol down. windows. The door mirrors are retracted* and
trol forward to the manual closing position the doors and tailgate are locked. To interrupt
When the ventilation position is selected the
instead. closing, press the lock button again.
front section is raised at its rear edge. If the
curtain is fully closed when ventilation position
NOTE is selected - then it opens automatically WARNING
For manual opening, the curtain must be approx. 50 mm.
If closing the panorama roof with the remote
fully open before the panorama roof can be control key, make sure nothing could
opened. For the reverse procedure, the become trapped.
panorama roof must be fully closed before
the curtain can be closed.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 99


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

Petrol and diesel engines 3. Press the START/STOP ENGINE button NOTE
and then release it.
The idling speed can be noticeably higher
The starter motor works until the engine has than normal for certain engine types during
started, but for no longer than 10 seconds (die- cold starting. This is so that the emissions
sel up to 60 seconds). system can reach normal operating tem-
perature as quickly as possible, which min-
03 If the engine has not started after 10 seconds imises exhaust emissions and protects the
- try again by holding in the START/STOP environment.
ENGINE button until the engine starts.

WARNING Keyless drive


Follow steps 2-3 to start a petrol engine. For
Always remove the remote control key from more information on Keyless drive, see
the ignition switch when leaving the car -
especially if there are children in the car. page 51.
Ignition switch with inserted remote control key
and START/STOP ENGINE button. NOTE
IMPORTANT WARNING One precondition for starting the car is that
Never remove the remote control key from one of the car's remote control keys with the
Do not press in the remote control key incor- keyless drive* function is located inside the
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detach- the ignition switch while driving or when the
car is being towed. The steering lock could passenger compartment or the cargo area.
able key blade, see page 48.
be activated which would mean that the car
cannot be steered. Stop the engine
1. Fit the remote control key in the ignition Never remove the remote control key with To switch off the engine - Press START/STOP
switch - Gently press the key until it is the Keyless drive* function from the car ENGINE.
drawn into the lock. while driving or during towing.
If the car has an automatic gearbox and the
2. Hold the clutch pedal fully depressed1. (For gear selector is not in a position P or if the car
cars with automatic gearbox - Depress the is moving - Press twice or hold the button
brake pedal.) depressed until the engine stops.

1 If the car is moving then it is enough to press the START/STOP ENGINE button to start the car.

100
03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

Steering lock2
The steering lock is deactivated when the
remote control key is inserted into the ignition
switch and is activated when the key is
removed from the lock.
Activate the steering lock when leaving the car
03
to reduce the risk of car theft.

Key positions
For information on the remote control key's dif-
ferent key positions, see page 73.

2 For cars with Keyless drive* the steering lock is deactivated when the START/STOP ENGINE button is pressed in for the first time. The steering lock is activated when the engine is switched off
and the driver's door is opened.

101
03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine – external battery

Jump starting 5. Open the clips on the front cover of the 11. Remove the jump leads, first the black and
battery in your car and remove the cover, then the red.
see page 244.
Make sure that none of the clamps on the
6. Connect the red jump lead to the battery's black jump lead comes into contact with
positive terminal . the battery's positive terminal or the clamp
connected to the red jump lead.
03 7. Connect one clamp from the black jump
lead to the donor battery's negative termi-
WARNING
nal .
The battery can generate oxyhydrogen gas,
which is highly explosive. One spark, which
IMPORTANT can be generated if you connect a jump lead
Connect the start cable carefully to avoid incorrectly, is sufficient to make the battery
short circuits with other components in the explode. The battery contains sulphuric
engine compartment. acid, which can cause serious burns. If the
If the battery is flat then the car can be started
acid comes into contact with eyes, skin or
with current from another battery. clothing, flush with large quantities of water.
The following points are recommended when 8. Connect the other clamp to an earthing If acid splashes into the eyes, seek medical
using a donor battery in order to avoid the risk point, (right-hand engine mounting at the attention immediately.
of an explosion: top, the outer screw head) . Check that
the jump lead clamps are fixed securely so
1. Insert the remote control key in key posi- that there are no sparks during the starting
tion 0, see page 73. procedure.
2. Ensure that the donor battery is 12 volt. 9. Start the engine of the "donor car". Let the
3. If the donor battery is in another car, switch engine run a few minutes at a speed slightly
off the donor car's engine in the other car higher than idle (1500 rpm).
and ensure that the cars do not touch one 10. Start the engine of the car with the flat bat-
another. tery. Do not touch the crocodile clips dur-
4. Connect the red jump lead to the positive ing the start procedure. There is a risk of
terminal on the donor battery . sparks forming.

102
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Manual - six-speed Reverse gear inhibitor - six-speed Automatic gearbox, Geartronic

03

• Depress the clutch pedal fully during each The reverse gear inhibitor hinders the possibil- The information display shows the position of
gear change. ity of mistakenly attempting to engage reverse the gear selector using the following indica-
gear during normal forward travel. tions: P, R, N, D, S, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6, see
• Take your foot off the clutch pedal between
gear changes. Only engage reverse gear when the car is sta- page 67.
• Follow the shifting pattern indicated. tionary.
Gear positions
For the best possible fuel economy, use the
Parking position (P)
highest gear possible as often as possible.
Select P when starting the engine or when the
car is parked. The brake pedal must be
depressed to disengage the gear selector from
the P position.
The gearbox is mechanically blocked when the
P position is engaged. Activate the electric
parking brake by pressing the button, see
page 112.

``

103
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

IMPORTANT depending on which gear is engaged just then, the gears. At the same time it responds more
see page 67. quickly to acceleration. During active driving,
The car must be stationary when position the use of a lower gear is prioritised, leading to
P is selected. Move the lever forwards towards + (plus) to
a delayed upshift.
change up a gear and release the lever, which
returns to its rest position at M. Sport mode is obtained by moving the lever
Reverse (R)
from D position to the end position at M. The
03 The car must be stationary when position R is Pull the lever back towards – (minus) to change
information display shifts the indication from
selected. down a gear and release the lever.
D to S.
Neutral position (N) The manual gearshift mode M can be selected
Sport mode can be selected at any time while
No gear is engaged and the engine can be at any time while driving.
driving.
started. Apply the parking brake if the car is Geartronic automatically shifts down if the
stationary with the gear selector in position N. driver allows the speed to decrease lower than Geartronic - Winter mode
Drive (D) a level suitable for the selected gear, in order It can be easier to pull away on slippery roads
D is the normal driving position. Shifting up and to avoid jerking and stalling. if 3rd gear is engaged manually.
down takes place automatically based on the 1. Depress the brake pedal and move the
To return to automatic driving mode: move the
level of acceleration and speed. The car must gear lever from the D position to the end
lever to the left-hand end position at D.
be stationary when the gear selector is moved position at M - the instrument panel display
to position D from position R. shifts the indication from D to the figure 1.
NOTE
Geartronic – manual gear positions (M) 2. Scroll up to gear 3 by pushing the lever
If the gearbox has a Sport programme then
The driver can also change gear manually forward towards + (plus) twice - the display
the gearbox will only become manual after
using the Geartronic automatic gearbox. The the lever has been moved forwards or back- shifts the indication from 1 to 3.
car engine-brakes when the accelerator pedal wards in its M position. The information dis- 3. Release the brake and accelerate carefully.
is released. play then shifts the indication from S to The gearbox "winter mode" means that the car
show which of the gears 1–6 is engaged.
Manual gearshift mode is obtained by moving moves off with a lower engine speed and
the lever from position D to the right-hand end reduced engine power on the drive wheels.
position at M. The information display shifts the Geartronic - Sport mode (S)1
indication from D to one of the figures "1-6", The Sport programme provides sportier cha-
racteristics and allows higher engine speed for

1 Only on the T6 model.

104
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Kick-down Mechanical gear selector inhibitor Parking position (P)


When the accelerator pedal is pressed all the Stationary car with engine running:
way to the floor (beyond the position normally
Keep your foot on the brake pedal when mov-
regarded as full acceleration) a lower gear is
ing the gear selector to another position.
immediately engaged. This is known as kick-
down. Electric gear inhibitor – Shiftlock Parking
position (P) 03
If the accelerator is released from the kick-
To be able to move the gear selector from P to
down position, the gearbox automatically
other gear positions, the brake pedal must be
changes up.
depressed and the remote control key in posi-
Kick-down is used when maximum accelera- tion II activated, see page 73.

G021351
tion is needed, such as for overtaking.
Shiftlock – Neutral (N)
Safety function If the gear selector is in the N position and the
To prevent overrevving the engine, the gearbox The gear selector can be moved forward and car has been stationary for at least 3 seconds
control program has a protective downshift back freely between N and D. Other positions (irrespective of whether the engine is running)
inhibitor which prevents the kick-down func- are locked with a latch that is released with the then the gear selector is locked.
tion. inhibitor button on the gear selector. To be able to move the gear selector from N to
Geartronic does not permit downshifting/kick- With the inhibitor button depressed the lever other gear positions, the brake pedal must be
down which would result in an engine speed can be moved forwards or backwards between depressed and the remote control key must be
high enough to damage the engine. Nothing P, R, N and D. in position II, see page 73.
happens if the driver still tries to shift down in
this way at high engine speed – the original Automatic gear selector inhibitor
gear remains engaged. The automatic gearbox has special safety sys-
tems:
When kick-down is activated the car can
change one or more gears at a time depending Keylock
on engine speed. The car changes up when the To remove the remote control key from the
engine reaches its maximum speed in order to ignition switch, the gear selector must be in the
prevent damage to the engine. P position. The remote control key is locked in
all other positions.

``

105
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Deactivating the automatic gear selector


inhibitor

03

G031390
If the car cannot be driven, e.g. due to a flat
battery, the gear selector must be moved from
the P position so that the car can be moved.
Lift the rubber mat in the compartment
behind the centre console and open the
hatch.
Fully insert the key blade. Press the key
blade down and hold (For information on
the key blade, see page 48.)
Move the gear selector from the P position.

106
03 Your driving environment

All-wheel drive – AWD*

All Wheel Drive is always engaged

03

All Wheel Drive means that the car is driving all


four wheels at the same time.
The power is automatically distributed
between the front and rear wheels. An elec-
tronically controlled clutch system distributes
the power to the wheels that have the best grip
on the current road surface. This provides the
best traction and prevents wheel spin. Under
normal driving conditions, the majority of
power is transmitted to the front wheels.
All Wheel Drive improves driving safety in rain,
snow and icy conditions.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 107


03 Your driving environment

Foot brake

General may be felt in the brake pedal when this is NOTE


The car is equipped with two brake circuits. If engaged and this is normal.
When EBA is activated the brake pedal low-
one brake circuit is damaged then this will A short test of the ABS system is made auto- ers slightly more than usual, depress (hold)
mean that the brakes engage at a deeper level matically after the engine has been started the brake pedal as long as necessary. If the
and harder pressure on the pedal is needed to when the driver releases the brake pedal. A brake pedal is released then all braking
produce the normal braking effect. further automatic test of the ABS system may ceases.
03 be made when the car reaches 40 km/h. The
The driver's brake pedal pressure is assisted
by a brake servo. test may be experienced as pulses in the brake Symbols in the combined instrument
pedal. panel
WARNING Cleaning the brake discs Symbol Specification
The brake servo only works when the engine Coatings of dirt and water on the brake discs
is running. may result in delayed brake function. This delay Constant glow – Check the
is minimised by cleaning the brake linings. brake fluid level. If the level is
low, fill with brake fluid and
If the brake is used when the engine is switched Manual cleaning is advisable with wet road sur- check for the cause of the brake
off then the pedal will feel stiff and more force faces, prior to long-stay parking and after the fluid loss.
must be used to brake the car. car has been washed. Carry this out by braking
In very hilly terrain or when driving with a heavy gently during a short period while en route. Constant glow for 2 seconds
load the brakes can be relieved by using engine when the engine is started –
Emergency Brake Assistance There was a fault in the brake
braking. Engine braking is most efficiently used
Emergency Brake Assistance EBA (Emergency system's ABS function when
if the same gear is used downhill as up.
Brake Assistance) helps to increase brake the engine was last running.
For more general information on heavy loads force and so reduce braking distance. The EBA
on the car, see page 278. system detects the driver's braking style and
increases brake force as necessary. The brake
Anti-lock braking system force can be reinforced up to the level when the
The car is equipped with ABS (Anti-lock ABS system is engaged. The EBA function is
Braking System) which prevents the wheels interrupted when the pressure on the brake
from locking during braking. This means the pedal is reduced.
ability to steer is maintained and it is easier to
swerve to avoid a hazard for example. Vibration

108
03 Your driving environment

Foot brake

WARNING
If and illuminate at the same
time, there may be a fault in the brake sys-
tem.
If the level in the brake fluid reservoir is nor-
mal at this stage, drive carefully to the near- 03
est workshop and have the brake system
checked - an authorised Volvo workshop is
recommended.
If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
before topping up the brake fluid.
The reason for the loss of brake fluid must
be investigated.

109
03 Your driving environment

Hill Descent Control (HDC)

General WARNING gear position 1 must be selected, which is


HDC can be compared to an automatic engine shown with the figure 1 in the trip computer
HDC does not work in all situations, but is display, see page 104.
brake. When you release the accelerator on instead only intended to be supplementary
downhill gradients the car is normally braked assistance.
by means of the engine striving for low engine NOTE
The driver always has ultimate responsibility
idling speeds, so-called engine braking. But HDC cannot be activated in an automatic
that the car is driven safely.
03 the steeper the road and the more load there is gearbox with the gear selector in position
in the car, the faster the car rolls despite engine D.
braking. In order to then reduce speed the Function
driver has to assist using the footbrake.
The function makes it possible to increase/ Operation
reduce speed on steep downhill gradients, with HDC allows the car to roll at a maximum of
a foot only on the accelerator pedal, without 10 km/h forwards with engine braking and
using the footbrake. The sensitivity of the 7 km/h backwards. However, any speed within
accelerator pedal decreases and becomes the gear's speed register can be selected using
more precise by means of the full actuation of the accelerator pedal. When the accelerator
the pedal being restricted to adjusting engine pedal is released, the car is braked quickly to
speed within a limited range. The brake system 10 or 7 km/h respectively, irrespective of the
brakes itself and provides the car with a low hill's gradient and without the need for the foot-
and even speed, so allowing the driver to fully brake.
focus on steering. The brake lights come on automatically when
HDC is particularly helpful on steep gradients the function is operating. The driver can brake
HDC is engaged or disengaged using a switch
with an uneven road surface and slippery sec- or stop the car at any time by using the foot-
on the centre console. An indicator lamp in the
tions. E.g. when launching a boat on a trailer brake.
button illuminates when the function is
from a ramp. switched on. When HDC is operating the HDC is deactivated:
symbol illuminates and the display
shows Hill descent control ON.
The function only operates in first gear position
and in reverse gear. For an automatic gearbox,

110
03 Your driving environment

Hill Descent Control (HDC)

• with the on/off button on the centre con-


sole
• if a gear higher than 1 is selected on a
manual gearbox
• if a gear higher than 1 is selected on an
automatic gearbox, or if the gear selector
is moved to position D. 03
The function can be disengaged at any time. If
it takes place on a steep downhill gradient then
the braking effect will not release directly, but
slowly instead.

NOTE
With HDC activated you may experience a
delay between acceleration pedal activation
and engine response.

111
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Parking brake, electric How to apply the parking brake ing the control. When the control is released or
An electric parking brake has the same appli- the accelerator pedal is depressed the braking
cations as a manual parking brake, e.g. when is interrupted.
starting uphill.
NOTE
Function
In the event of emergency braking at speeds
03 A faint electric motor noise can be heard when
above 10 km/h a signal sounds during the
the parking brake is being applied. The noise braking procedure.
can also be heard during the automatic func-
tion checking of the parking brake.
Parking on a hill
If the car is stationary when the parking brake If the car is parked facing uphill; turn the wheels

G021354
is applied then it only acts on the rear wheels. away from the kerb.
If it is applied when the car is moving then the
normal foot brake is used, i.e. the brake acts Parking brake control. If the car is parked facing downhill, turn the
on all four wheels. Brake function changes over 1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly. wheels towards the kerb.
to the rear wheels when the car is almost sta-
2. Press the control. How to release the parking brake
tionary.
3. Release the foot brake pedal and make
Low battery voltage sure that the car is at a standstill position.
If the battery voltage is too low then the parking
brake can neither be released nor applied. • When parking the vehicle, always engage
Connect a donor battery if the battery voltage 1st gear (for manual gearbox) or put the
gear selector in position P (for automatic
is too low, see page 102.
gearbox).
The symbol in the combined instrument
panel flashes until the parking brake is fully
applied. When the symbol illuminates the park-

G021359
ing brake is applied.
In an emergency the parking brake can be Parking brake control.
applied when the vehicle is moving by depress-

112
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Cars with manual gearbox 2. Insert the remote control key in the ignition Cars with Keyless drive function
switch. Release manually by pressing the
Releasing manually
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition 3. Depress the brake pedal firmly. START/STOP ENGINE button, then depress
switch. the brake or clutch pedal and pull the control.
4. Pull the control.
2. Depress the brake pedal firmly. Releasing automatically Symbols
3. Pull the control. 1. Put the seatbelt on. Symbol Specification 03
2. Start the engine. Read the message on the infor-
NOTE mation display
3. Move the gear selector to position D or R
The parking brake can also be released and depress the accelerator.
manually by depressing the clutch pedal A flashing symbol indicates that
instead of the brake pedal. Volvo recom- the parking brake is applied. If
mends the use of the brake pedal. NOTE the symbol flashes in any other
For safety reasons, the parking brake is only situation then this means that a
Releasing automatically released automatically if the engine is run- fault has arisen. Read the mes-
ning and the driver is wearing a seatbelt. The sage on the information display.
1. Start the engine. parking brake is released immediately on
2. Ease up the clutch and depress the accel- cars with automatic gearbox when the
accelerator pedal is depressed and the gear
Messages
erator.
selector is in position D or R.
IMPORTANT
Heavy load uphill
It is possible to release the parking brake
A heavy load, such as a trailer, can cause the
automatically, even when the gear lever is in
neutral position, if the engine is running. car to roll backward when the parking brake is
released automatically on a steep incline.
Avoid this by depressing the control while driv-
Cars with automatic gearbox ing off. Release the control when the engine
Releasing manually achieves traction.

G016166
1. Put the seatbelt on.

``

113
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Park brake not fully released - A fault is pre-


venting the parking brake from being released.
Visit a workshop - an authorised Volvo work-
shop is recommended. A warning signal
sounds if you pull away with this error mes-
sage.
03 Parking brake not applied - A fault is pre-
venting the parking brake from being applied.
Try to apply and release. Visit a workshop if the
message remains - a Volvo workshop is rec-
ommended.
The message is also illuminated on cars with
manual gearbox when the car is driven at low
speed with the door open in order to alert the
driver that the parking brake may have been
unintentionally disengaged.
Parking brake Service required - A fault has
arisen. Visit a workshop if the fault persists - a
Volvo workshop is recommended.
If the car has to be parked before the fault has
been rectified then the wheels must be turned
as if parking on a hill and 1st gear engaged
(manual gearbox) or the gear selector must be
in position P (automatic gearbox).

Replacing the brake linings


The rear brake linings must be replaced at a
workshop due to the design of the electric
parking brake - an authorised Volvo workshop
is recommended.

114
03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

General NOTE The original remote controls can of course be


used in parallel with HomeLinkŸ.
HomeLink is designed to be inoperable if
the car is locked from the outside.
WARNING
Save the original remote controls for future
programming (e.g. for purchasing a new If HomeLinkŸ is used to operate a garage
car). door or gate, ensure that nobody is in the
vicinity of the door or gate while it is in 03
Erase the programming for the buttons motion.
when selling the car.
Do not use the HomeLinkŸ remote control
Metallic sun visors should not be used in
for any garage door that does not have
cars equipped with HomeLink. This could
safety stop and safety reverse. The garage
have a negative effect on the HomeLink
door must react immediately when it
function.
detects that something is preventing its
movement, and stop directly and reverse. A
HomeLinkŸ is a programmable remote control Operation garage door without these characteristics
which can control up to three different devices could cause personal injury. For further
When HomeLinkŸ is fully programmed it can be
(e.g. garage door, alarm system, outdoor light- information - contact the supplier via the
used in place of the separate original remote Internet: www.homelink.com.
ing and indoor lighting etc.) and in doing so
controls.
replace their remote controls. HomeLink is
supplied built into the left-hand sun visor. Depress the programmed button to activate Programming for the first time
the garage door, alarm system etc. The indi- The first step erases the memory in
The HomeLinkŸ panel consists of three pro- cator lamp illuminates for the time that the but-
grammable buttons and one indicator lamp. HomeLinkŸ and must not be carried out when
ton is kept depressed.
only one individual button is being reprogram-
med.
NOTE
1. Depress the two outer buttons and do not
In the event that the ignition is not activated, release until the indicator lamp starts to
HomeLink operates for 30 minutes after the flash after approx. 20 seconds. The flash-
driver's door has been opened.
ing indicates that HomeLinkŸ is set in
"learn mode" and is ready to be pro-
grammed.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 115


03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

2. Position the original remote control • Glow not constant: The indicator lamp Programming individual buttons
5-30 cm from HomeLinkŸ. Monitor the indi- flashes quickly for approx. 2 seconds To reprogram an individual button, proceed in
cator lamp. and then changes over to a constant accordance with the following:
glow for approx. 3 seconds. This proc-
The particular distance that is required ess is repeated for approx. 20 seconds 1. Depress the required button on
between the original remote control and and indicates that the device has a "roll- HomeLinkŸ and do not release until step 3
HomeLinkŸ depends on the programming ing code". The garage door, gate or sim- has been completed.
03
of the device in question. Perhaps several ilar is not activated when the pro- 2. When the indicator lamp on HomeLinkŸ
attempts will be required at different dis- grammed HomeLinkŸ button is starts to flash, after approx. 20 seconds,
tances. Maintain each position for approx. depressed. Continue the programming
position the original remote control
15 seconds before trying a new one. in accordance with the following.
5-30 cm from HomeLinkŸ. Monitor the indi-
3. Depress the button for the original remote 5. Locate the "programming button1" on the cator lamp.
control and the button to be programmed receiver for the garage door for example,
The particular distance that is required
on HomeLinkŸ simultaneously. Do not normally located close to the antenna's
between the original remote control and
release the buttons until the indicator lamp bracket on the receiver. If you have diffi-
HomeLink depends on the programming of
has changed over from slow to rapid flash- culty in finding the button - consult the
the device in question. Perhaps several
ing. The rapid flashing indicates successful supplier's manual, or contact the supplier
attempts will be required at different dis-
programming. via the Internet: www.homelink.com.
tances. Maintain each position for approx.
4. Test the programming by depressing the 6. Depress and release the "programming 15 seconds before trying a new one.
programmed button on HomeLinkŸ and button". The button flashes for
3. Depress the button on the original remote
watching the indicator lamp: approx. 30 seconds and the next step must
control. The indicator lamp will start to
be carried out within this period.
• Constant glow: The indicator lamp illu- flash. When the flashing has changed over
minates with a constant glow when the 7. Depress the programmed button on from a slow to a rapid flashing - release
button is kept depressed, this indicates HomeLinkŸ, while the "programming but- both buttons. The rapid flashing indicates
that the programming is complete. The ton" is still flashing, keep it depressed for successful programming.
garage door, gate or similar should now approx. 3 seconds and then release.
be activated when the programmed 4. Test the programming by depressing the
Repeat the press/hold/release sequence
HomeLinkŸ button is depressed. programmed button on HomeLink and
up to 3 times to conclude the program-
watching the indicator lamp:
ming.

1 Button designation and colour vary depending on manufacturer.

116 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

• Constant glow: The indicator lamp illu- 7. Depress the programmed button on
minates with a constant glow when the HomeLinkŸ, while the "programming but-
button is kept depressed, this indicates ton" is still flashing, keep it depressed for
that the programming is complete. The approx. 3 seconds and then release.
garage door, gate or similar should now Repeat the press/hold/release sequence
be activated when the programmed up to 3 times to conclude the program-
HomeLinkŸ button is depressed. ming. 03
• Glow not constant: The indicator lamp
flashes quickly for approx. 2 seconds Erasing programming
and then changes over to a constant It is only possible to erase the programming for
glow for approx. 3 seconds. This proc- all the buttons on HomeLink, not for individual
ess is repeated for approx. 20 seconds buttons.
and indicates that the device has a "roll- ± Depress the two outer buttons and do not
ing code". The garage door, gate or sim-
release until the indicator lamp starts to
ilar is not activated when the pro-
flash after approx. 20 seconds.
grammed HomeLinkŸ button is
depressed. Continue the programming > HomeLinkŸ is now set in so-called
in accordance with the following. "learn mode" and is ready to be pro-
grammed once more, see page 115.
5. Locate the "programming button2" on the
receiver for the garage door for example,
normally located close to the antenna's
bracket on the receiver. If you have diffi-
culty in finding the button - consult the
supplier's manual, or contact the supplier
via the Internet: www.homelink.com.
6. Depress and release the "programming
button". The button flashes for approx. 30
seconds and the next step must be carried
out within this period.

2 Button designation and colour vary depending on manufacturer.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 117


Menus and messages........................................................................... 120
Climate control...................................................................................... 126
Fuel-driven engine block heater
and passenger compartment heater*................................................... 133
Fuel-driven additional heater*............................................................... 136
Audio system........................................................................................ 137
Trip computer........................................................................................ 150
DSTC – Stability and traction control system....................................... 152
Adapting driving characteristics........................................................... 154
Cruise control*...................................................................................... 155
Adaptive cruise control*........................................................................ 156
Distance Alert........................................................................................ 162
City Safety™......................................................................................... 165
Collision Warning with Auto Brake*...................................................... 170
Driver Alert System – DAC*................................................................... 175
Driver Alert System - LDW*................................................................... 178
Park assist syst*.................................................................................... 181
Park assist camera*.............................................................................. 184
BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System................................................ 187
Comfort inside the passenger compartment........................................ 191
Bluetooth handsfree*............................................................................ 194

G020908
Built-in phone*...................................................................................... 199

118 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


COMFORT AND DRIVING PLEASURE

04
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Centre console ENTER – selects menu options The search paths to the menu system's func-
Some functions are controlled from the centre tions are stated in the form: Car settings
Numerical keypad 1–9
console via the menu system or via the keypad Lock settings, which presupposes that fol-
in the steering wheel. Each function is descri- lowing is carried out before:
Steering wheel keypad*
bed under its respective section. 1. Press MENU.
The current menu level is shown at the top right 2. Scroll to the required menu, e.g. Car
of the centre console's display.
settings, using the navigation buttons and
Centre console controls press ENTER.
3. Scroll to the required submenu, e.g. Lock
04 settings, and press ENTER.
The navigation buttons can be used instead of
ENTER and EXIT when navigating in the menu
hierarchy. The right-hand arrow is equal to
ENTER and the left-hand arrow to EXIT.
The menu options are numbered and can also
ENTER
be selected directly with the numerical keypad
EXIT (only 1–9).

Navigation buttons – up/down. Menu overview


Centre console with controls for menu navigation. The phone and audio sources each have sep-
If the steering wheel keypad has ENTER and
arate main menus. An audio source main menu
Navigation button – scrolls and selects EXIT then these buttons, and the navigation
(e.g. CD) can only be accessed when that par-
among menu options buttons, have the same functions as the con-
ticular audio source is active, see page 138.
MENU – leads to the menu system trols in the centre console.
The following menu options are included in
EXIT – leads back one step in the menu Search paths Main menu:
structure. A long press leads out from the Access to some functions is provided directly
via the function buttons and some are reached Car Key memory
menu system.
via the menu system. Seat & mirror positions*

120 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Car settings Main menu AM Folder4


Information Audio settings Disc4
Light settings Sound stage Single disc5
Lock settings Equalizer front All discs5
Reduced guard1 Equalizer rear CD settings
Tyre pressure* Auto. volume control Track information*
Side mirror settings* Reset all audio settings News
Collision warning settings* Main menu FM TP (Traffic information) 04
Parking camera settings* FM settings Audio settings2
Lane departure warning* News Main menu AUX
Steering force level* TP (Traffic information) AUX input volume
Unit settings Radio text Audio settings2
Driver Alert on PTY (Program type) Main menu USB
Climate settings Advanced radio settings USB settings
Automatic blower adjust Audio settings2 News
Recirculation timer Main menu DAB*3 TP (Traffic information)
Auto. rear defroster Main menu CD Audio settings2
Reset climate settings Random Track information
Off

1 Available in certain models.


2 For submenus, see "Main menu AM/Audio settings".
3 See page 147.
4 Only in systems that allow the playback of MP3 and WMA format audio files.
5 Only in systems with CD changer.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 121


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Main menu iPod Synchronise phone book Call options


iPod settings Main menu, built-in phone Send my number
News Call register Call waiting
TP (Traffic information) Last 10 missed calls Automatic answer
Audio settings2 Last 10 received calls Auto redial
Track information Last 10 dialled calls Voice mail number
Main menu, Bluetooth Erase list Diversions
Last 10 missed calls Call duration Phone settings
04
Last 10 received calls Phone book Network selection
Last 10 dialled calls New contact SIM security
Phone book Search Edit PIN code
Search Copy all Sounds and volume
Copy fr. mobile phone Erase SIM IDIS
Bluetooth* Erase phone Reset Phone settings
Connect phone Memory status
Change phone Speed-dial
Remove phone Messages
Car Bluetooth info Read
Phone settings Write new
Call options Message settings
Sounds and volume Erase message

2 For submenus, see "Main menu AM/Audio settings".

122 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Combined instrument panel Menu overview6 Message


To empty fuel tank
Average
Instantaneous
Average speed
Lane departure warning
Tyre pressure Calibration
City Safety
04

G021364
Current speed
Park heat timer 1/2
Information display and controls for menus. Text message in the information display.
Park vent timer 1/2
READ – access to message list and mes- When a warning, information or indicator sym-
sage confirmation. Park timer mode bol illuminates, a corresponding message
Thumbwheel – browse between menu Direct start Park heat appears on the information display. An error
options. message is stored in a memory list until the
Direct start Park el.heat fault is rectified.
RESET – reset the active function. Used in
certain cases to select/activate a function, Direct start Park vent Press READ to acknowledge and browse
see the explanation under each respective Additional heat auto between the messages.
function.
Rest heat start
The menus shown on the information displays NOTE
in the combined instrument panel are con- DSTC
If a warning message appears while you are
trolled with the left-hand stalk switch. The using the trip computer, the message must
menus shown depend on key position, see be read (press READ) before the previous
page 73. If a message appears then this must activity can be resumed.
be acknowledged with READ for the menus to
be shown.

``

123
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Message Specification Message Specification Message Specification


Stop safely Stop and switch off the Book time for Time to book regular Transmission Volvo recommends that
engine. Serious risk of maintenance service. Volvo recom- oil Change nee- you engage an author-
damage. Volvo recom- mends that you contact ded ised Volvo workshop to
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo check the car as soon
an authorised Volvo workshop. as possible.
workshop.
Time for regular Time for regular service. Transmission Transmission cannot
Stop engine Stop and switch off the maintenance Volvo recommends that performance handle full capacity.
engine. Serious risk of you contact an author- low Drive with care until the
04 damage. Volvo recom- ised Volvo workshop. message clears.
mends that you contact The timing is deter-
If shown repeatedly:
an authorised Volvo mined by the number of
Volvo recommends that
workshop. kilometres driven, num-
you contact an author-
ber of months since the
Service urgent Volvo recommends that ised Volvo workshop.
last service, engine run-
you engage an author- ning time and oil grade. Transmission Drive more smoothly or
ised Volvo workshop to
hot Reduce stop the car in a safe
check the car immedi- Maintenance If the service intervals
speed manner. Disengage the
ately. overdue are not followed then
gear and run the engine
the warranty does not
Service Volvo recommends that at idling speed until the
cover any damaged
required you engage an author- message clears.
parts. Volvo recom-
ised Volvo workshop to mends that you contact Transmission Critical fault. Stop the
check the car as soon an authorised Volvo hot Stop safely car immediately in a
as possible. workshop for service. safe manner. Volvo rec-
See manual Read the owner's man- ommends that you con-
ual. tact an authorised
Volvo workshop.

6 Certain menu options.

124
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Message Specification
Temporarily A function has been
OFF temporarily switched
off and is reset auto-
matically while driving
or after starting again.

Power save The audio system is


mode switched off to save
energy. Charge the bat-
tery. 04

125
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

General Sensor location air conditioning can be temporarily switched


• The sun sensor* is located on the top side off. There may then be a temporary increase in
Air conditioning of the dashboard. temperature in the passenger compartment.
The car is equipped with Electronic Climate
Control (ECC). The climate control system
• The temperature sensor for the passenger
Condensation
compartment is located below the climate
cools or heats as well as dehumidifies the air in In warm weather, condensation from the air
control panel.
the passenger compartment. conditioning may drip under the car. This is
• The outside temperature sensor is located normal.
on the door mirror.
NOTE
• The humidity sensor* is located in the inte- Ice and snow
The air conditioning can be switched off, but rior rearview mirror. Remove ice and snow from the climate control
04 to ensure the best possible climate comfort system air intake (the grille between the bonnet
in the passenger compartment and to pre- and the windscreen).
vent the windows from misting, it should NOTE
always be on. Do not cover or block the sensors with Fault tracing and repair
clothing or other objects. Engage a workshop that has authorisation for
Actual temperature the fault tracing and repair of the climate con-
The temperature you select corresponds to the Side windows and panorama roof trol system. Volvo recommends that you con-
physical experience with reference to factors To ensure that the air conditioning works opti- tact an authorised Volvo workshop.
such as air speed, humidity and solar radia- mally the side windows, and panorama roof if
tion* in and around the car. Refrigerant
appropriate, should be closed.
The climate control system contains R134a
The system includes a sun sensor* which refrigerant, see page 280. This refrigerant con-
Misting windows
detects on which side the sun is shining into tains no chlorine, which means that it is harm-
Remove misting on the insides of the windows
the passenger compartment. This means that less to the ozone layer. Engage a workshop
by primarily using the defroster function.
the temperature can differ between the right that has authorisation for filling/changing
and left-hand air vents despite the controls To reduce the risk of misting, keep the win- refrigerant to carry out the work. Volvo recom-
being set for the same temperature on both dows clean and use window cleaner. mends that you contact an authorised Volvo
sides. workshop.
Temporary shut-off of the air
conditioning Total airing function
When the engine requires full power, e.g. for full The function opens/closes all side windows
acceleration or driving uphill with a trailer, the simultaneously and can be used for example to

126 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

quickly air the car during hot weather, see is reduced gradually due to reduced need Menu settings
page 53. up until the car is 4 years old. It is possible to change the default settings for
• The air quality system IAQS is a fully auto- three of the climate control system's functions
Passenger compartment filter matic system that cleans the air in the pas- via the centre console, see page 120:
All air entering the car's passenger compart- senger compartment from contaminants
ment is cleaned with a filter. This must be such as particles, hydrocarbons, nitrous
• Fan speed in automatic mode*, see
replaced at regular intervals. Follow the Volvo page 129.
oxides and ground-level ozone.
Service Programme for the recommended • Recirculation timer for passenger com-
replacement intervals. If the car is used in a partment air, see page 130.
NOTE
severely contaminated environment, it may be • Automatic rear window defrosting, see
necessary to replace the filter more often. In cars with CZIP the IAQS filter should be page 95.
changed after 15 000 km or once per year 04
depending on whichever occurs first. How- All climate control system functions are set to
NOTE ever, up to 75 000 km over 5 years. In cars original position with RESET via the display.
There are different types of passenger com- without CZIP the IAQS filter must be
partment filter. Make sure that the correct changed at the normal service.
Air distribution
filter is fitted.
Use of tested materials in the interior
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)* equipment.
This option keeps the passenger compartment The materials have been developed in order to
clear of allergy and asthma inducing sub- minimise the quantity of dust in the passenger
stances. For more information on CZIP, see the compartment and they contribute to making
brochure included with the purchase of the car. the passenger compartment easier to keep
clean. The carpets in both the passenger com-
The following is included:
partment and the cargo area are removable
• An enhanced fan function that means that and easy to remove and clean. Use cleaning
the fan starts when the car is opened with agents and car care products recommended

G032070
the remote control key. The fan fills the by Volvo, see page 266.
passenger compartment with fresh air. The
function starts when required and is dis- The incoming air is divided between
engaged automatically after a time or when 20 different vents in the passenger compart-
one of the passenger compartment doors ment.
is opened. The amount of time the fan runs
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 127


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Air distribution is fully automatic in AUTO Air vents in the door pillars Climate control
mode*.
Electronic climate control, ECC
If necessary it can be controlled manually, see
page 132.

Air vents in the dashboard

04

Closed
Open Fan
Lateral airflow Air distribution

Open Vertical airflow Heated front seats, left-hand side

Closed Aim the vents at the windows to remove mist- AUTO


ing.
Lateral airflow Heated front seats, right-hand side
Aim the vents into the passenger compartment
Vertical airflow to maintain a comfortable climate in the rear Temperature control, right-hand side
seat.
Aim the outer vents at the side windows to AC ON/OFF – Air conditioning On/Off
remove misting.
NOTE Rear window and door mirror defrosters,
A certain air flow always comes from the vents see page 95
Remember that small children may be sen-
in order to maintain a good climate in the pas- sitive to air flows and draughts. Max. defroster
senger compartment.

128 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Recirculation/Air quality system Press the button three times for the lowest heat Air distribution
level – one lamp illuminates. The figure consists of three
Temperature control, left-hand side
Press the button four times to switch off the buttons. When the buttons
heat – no lamps illuminate. are pressed a lamp in front of
Operation the respective part of the fig-
ure illuminates and shows
Fan
WARNING
which air distribution is
Turn the knob to increase or The heated seat should not be used by peo- selected, see page 132.
decrease fan speed. If AUTO ple who find it difficult to perceive tempera-
is selected then fan speed is ture increase because of sensory loss or for Auto
any reason have difficulty in managing to The Auto function automati-
regulated automatically. The
use the control of the heated seat. Other- cally regulates temperature, 04
previously set fan speed is wise, burn injuries may arise.
disengaged. air conditioning, fan speed,
recirculation, and air distribu-
Rear seats1 tion.
NOTE
If the fan is fully disengaged the air condi-
tioning is not engaged which may result in a If you select one or more manual functions, the
risk of misting windows. other functions continue to be controlled auto-
matically. The air quality sensor is engaged and
all manual settings are switched off when
Heated seats*
AUTO is pressed. The display shows AUTO
Front seats CLIMATE.
Press the button once for the
Fan speed in automatic mode can be set up
highest heat level – three
lamps illuminate. under the menu: Climate settings

G021376
Automatic blower adjust. Choose between
Press the button twice for a Low, Normal or High:
lower heat level – two lamps
illuminate. Heat control takes place in the same way as for
the front seat.

1 Not included if 2-stage booster cushion is selected.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 129


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

• Low - Automatic fan control. Low airflow OFF: When the defroster function is activated Recirculation/Air quality system
is prioritised. the air conditioning is switched on automati-
Recirculation
• Normal - Automatic fan control. cally (can be switched off using the AC button).
When recirculation is
• High - Automatic fan control. A more Defroster engaged the right-hand
intense airflow is prioritised. Used to quickly remove mist- orange light in the button illu-
For a description of the menu system, see ing and ice from the wind- minates. The function is
page 120. screen and side windows. Air selected to shut out bad air,
flowing to the windows. The exhaust gases etc. from the
Temperature control light in the defroster button passenger compartment. The
The temperatures on the illuminates when the function air in the passenger compartment is recircula-
04 driver and passenger sides is active. ted, i.e. no outside air is taken into the car when
can be set independently. this function is activated.
The following also takes place in order to pro-
When the car is started, the vide maximum dehumidification in the passen-
most recent setting is NOTE
ger compartment:
resumed. If the air in the car recirculates for too long,
• the air conditioning is automatically there is a risk of misting on the insides of the
engaged windows.
NOTE
• recirculation and the air quality system are
Heating or cooling cannot be hastened by automatically disengaged.
selecting a higher/lower temperature than Timer
the actual temperature required. The air conditioning can be disengaged man- With the timer function activated the system
ually using the AC button. When the defroster will exit manually activated recirculation mode
function is switched off the climate control sys- according to a time that depends on the out-
AC – Air conditioning on/off tem returns to the previous settings. side temperature. This reduces the risk of ice,
ON: The air conditioning is
misting and bad air. Activate/deactivate the
controlled by the system's
function under Climate settings
Auto function. This way,
incoming air is cooled and Recirculation timer. For a description of the
dehumidified. menu system, see page 120.

130
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

NOTE • The left-hand orange lamp illuminates – the Activating recirculation


air quality sensor is disengaged. There is Switch between recirculation
When Defroster is selected, recirculation is no recirculation, only fresh air. On/Off by pressing the button
always deactivated.
• The centre green lamp illuminates – recir- repeatedly. The lamp illumi-
culation not engaged, providing it is not nates when recirculation is
Air quality system* required for cooling in hot weather. engaged.
The air quality system sepa- • The right-hand orange lamp illuminates –
rates gases and particles to recirculation is engaged.
reduce the levels of odours
and pollution in the passenger
NOTE
compartment. If the outside
The air quality sensor should always be 04
air is contaminated then the
air intake is closed and the air engaged in order to obtain the best air in the
is recirculated. When the AUTO button is passenger compartment.
depressed the air quality sensor is always Recirculation is limited in cold weather to
engaged. avoid misting.
Activating recirculation/air quality If the insides of the windows start misting
sensor up, disengage the air quality sensor, and the
defroster functions for the windscreen, the
Switch between the three side and the rear windows should also be
functions by pressing the but- used to demist the windows.
ton repeatedly.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 131


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Air distribution table


Air distribution Use Air distribution Use
Air to windows. Some air to remove ice and misting Air to the floor and win- to ensure comfortable
flows from the air vents. quickly. dows. Some air flows conditions and good
The air is not recirculated. from the dashboard air demisting in cold or
Air conditioning is always vents. humid weather.
engaged.

Air to windscreen and to prevent misting and Air to floor and from dash- in sunny weather with
04 side windows. Some air icing in a cold and humid board air vents. cool outside tempera-
flows from the air vents. climate, (not at too low fan tures.
speed to enable this).

Airflow to windows and to ensure good comfort in Air to floor. Some air flows to direct heat or cold to
from dashboard air vents. warm, dry weather. to the dashboard air vents the floor.
and windows.

Airflow to the head and to ensure efficient cooling Airflow to windows, from to provide cooler air along
chest from the dashboard in warm weather. dashboard air vents and the floor or warmer air
air vents. to the floor. higher up in cold weather
or hot, dry weather.

132
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

Fuel-driven heater Refuelling Battery and fuel


If the battery has insufficient charge or the fuel
General information about the parking level is too low, the parking heater will be
heater switched off automatically and a message
The parking heater heats the engine and pas- appears on the information display. Acknowl-
senger compartment and can be started edge the message by pressing the indicator
directly or with the timer. stalk READ button once, see page 134.
Two different times can be selected using the
timer. Here, time refers to the time when the car IMPORTANT
is heated and ready. The car's electronic sys- Repeated use of the parking heater com-
tem calculates when heating should be started bined with short journeys may discharge the 04
based on the outside temperature. battery and impair starting.
The heater cannot start if the outside tempera- Warning label on fuel filler flap. The car should be driven for the same time
ture exceeds 15 °C. At –10 °C or lower the as the heater is used to ensure that the car's
maximum running time of the parking heater is battery is recharged adequately to replace
WARNING the energy consumed by the heater when it
50 minutes.
Fuel which spills out can be ignited. Switch is used on a regular basis.
WARNING off the fuel-driven heater before starting to
refuel.
The car must be outdoors when the parking
Check the information display to see that
heater is used.
the parking heater is switched off. When it
is running, the information display shows
NOTE Park heat ON.

When the parking heater is active there may


be smoke from the right-hand wheel hous- Parking on a hill
ing, which is perfectly normal. If the car is parked on a steep hill, the front of
the car should point downhill to ensure that
there is a supply of fuel to the parking heater.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 133


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

Operation Sym- Display Specification Sym- Display Specification


bol bol
Fuel The heater is Heater Setting the heater
heater switched on and unavail. is not possible due

G025102

G025102
ON running. Low fuel to fuel level being
level too low
Timer is The heater will (approx. 7 litres).
set for start at the set time
Heater not work-

G025102
Fuel after the car has Park
heater been left, when the heater ing. Contact a
04

G025102
remote control key Service workshop for

G021364
is removed from required repair. Volvo rec-
the ignition switch. ommends that you
READ button contact an author-
Heater The heater has ised Volvo work-
Thumbwheel been stopped by
stopped shop.

G025102
RESET button Low bat- the car's electron-
tery ics in order to facil-
For more information on the information dis- A display text clears automatically after a time
itate starting the
play and READ, see page 123. or after one press on the indicator stalk
engine.
READ button.

Symbols and display messages


Direct start and immediate stop
When one of the timer's settings or
Direct start is activated, the infor- 1. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Direct start
mation symbol in the combined instrument Park heat.
panel illuminates while the information display 2. Press RESET to select between ON and
shows an explanatory text and a further illumi- OFF.
nated symbol. The table shows symbols and
display texts that appear. ON: Parking heater switched on manually or
with programmed timer.

134 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

OFF: Parking heater switched off. 4. Briefly press RESET to move to the flash- Clock/timer
ing minutes setting. The heater's time is connected to the car's
Following the direct start of the heater it will be
activated for 50 minutes. 5. Select the required minute using the clock.
thumbwheel.
Heating of the passenger compartment will NOTE
begin as soon as the engine coolant has 6. Briefly press RESET to confirm the setting.
reached the correct temperature. All timer programming will be cleared if the
7. Press RESET to activate the timer. car's clock is reset.
NOTE After setting Park heat timer 1 a second start
time can be programmed with Park heat timer
The car can be started and driven while the 2 by scrolling to it with the thumbwheel.
parking heater is running. 04
Set the alternative time in the same way as
Park heat timer 1.
Setting the timer
The time when the car shall be used and heated Deactivating a timer-started heater
is specified with the timer. A timer-started heater can be switched off
manually before the set time has elapsed. Pro-
Select between TIMER 1 and TIMER 2. ceed as follows:
1. Press READ.
NOTE
2. Use the thumbwheel to scroll to the text
The timer can only be programmed when
the remote control key is in key position I, Park heat timer 1 or 2.
see page 73. > The text ON flashes on the display.
3. Press RESET.
1. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Park heat > The text OFF is shown with a constant
timer 1. glow and the heater is switched OFF.
2. Briefly press RESET to move to the flash- A timer-started heater can be switched off in
ing hours setting. accordance with the instructions in the section
3. Select the required hour using the thumb- "Direct start and immediate stop", see
wheel. page 134.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 135


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven additional heater*

Additional heater (diesel) NOTE


When the additional heater is active there
may be smoke from the right-hand wheel
housing which is perfectly normal.

Auto mode or shutdown


The additional heater can be switched off for
short distances if required.
1. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Additional
04 heat auto.

G021364
2. Press RESET to select between ON and
OFF.
READ button
Passenger compartment heater*
Thumbwheel If the additional heater is supplemented with
RESET button timer function then it will be a fuel-driven pas-
senger compartment heater, see page 133.
In diesel-engined cars the additional heater
may be required for achieving the correct tem-
perature in the engine and passenger com-
partment during cold weather.
The heater starts automatically when extra
heat is required when the engine is running.
The heater is switched off automatically when
the correct temperature is reached or when the
engine is switched off.

136 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

General If the audio system is active when the engine is Steering wheel keypad*
The audio system can be equipped with differ- switched off then it is activated automatically
ent options and is one of the following three next time the engine is started.
basic versions:
• Performance Overview
• High Performance
• Premium Sound
The system version is shown in the display
when the audio system is started.
Dolby Surround Pro Logic II and the Dolby 04
symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories Licensing Corporation. Dolby
Confirm selection in menu system, accept
Surround Pro Logic II System is manufactured
phone call.
under license from Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation. Lead up in menu system. Interrupt current
function, end/refuse phone calls, clear
Remote control key and key positions Input for external audio source; AUX and entered characters.
The audio system can be used without the USB (e.g. iPodŸ)1 Volume
remote control key in the ignition switch for
Steering wheel keypad
15 minutes at a time. A short press scrolls between CD tracks or
Information display preset radio stations. A long press fast-
NOTE winds CD tracks or seeks the next availa-
Centre console control panel ble radio station.
Remove the remote control key from the
ignition switch if the audio system is used Control panel with headphones socket*
when the engine is switched off. This is to
avoid discharging the battery unnecessar-
ily.

1 USB only applies for High Performance and Premium Sound. The iPod trademark belongs to Apple Computer Inc.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 137


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

Rear control panel with headphones Activating/deactivating Audio functions


socket The control panel is activated with MODE.
Headphones with an impedance of Deactivation is possible via a long press on
16-32 ohm and sensitivity of 102 dB or higher MODE or when the engine is switched off.
are recommended for best sound reproduc-
tion.
Scroll/search forward and backward
Short presses on (2) are used to scroll between
CD tracks or preset radio stations. A long press
fast-winds CD tracks or seeks the next availa-
ble radio station.

04 Limitations
• The audio source (FM, AM, CD etc.) played
back in the speakers cannot be controlled
from the rear control panel. Centre console, controls for audio functions.
AM, FM and CD - Internal audio sources.
MODE - Scroll between external audio
sources (AUX, USB* and DAB1/DAB2*).
For connection via AUX or USB, see
VOLUME – Volume, left and right. page 140.
Scroll/search forward and backward. SOUND – Push button and knob controls
for adjusting the sound pattern.
MODE - Select between AM, FM, CD,
Navigation button
AUX, USB*(e.g. iPodŸ), DAB1/DAB2* and
On/Off. For connection via AUX or USB, VOLUME - Volume and On/Off.
see page 140.
Headphones sockets (3.5 mm). Audio volume and automatic volume
control
The audio system compensates for disrupting
noises in the passenger compartment by
increasing the volume with the speed of the

138 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

car. The level of compensation can be set at NOTE • Surround* – Surround settings.
low, medium or high. Select the level under Under Surround 3 channel stereo or Dolby
Audio settings Auto. volume control. Press MENU to access the audio settings.
For more information, see page 120. Surround Pro Logic II can be activated by
selecting 3-ch or Dpl2 respectively. This ena-
External audio source audio volume bles the following options:
The AUX input can be used for connecting an • Bass - Bass level.
MP3 player which has no USB connection for • Treble - Treble level. • Centre level* – Level for centre speaker.
example, see page 140. • Surround levelSurround level* – Level
• Fader – Balance between the front and for surround.
rear speakers.
NOTE Equalizer
• Balance – Balance between the left and
The audio quality may be impaired if the right-hand speakers. The equalizer2 can be used to adjust different 04
player is charged while the audio system is frequency bands separately.
in AUX mode. In which case, avoid charging • Subwoofer* - Bass speaker level. Turning
the player via the 12 V socket. the control anticlockwise to MIN deac- 1. Go to Audio settings and select
tivates the Subwoofer. The Subwoofer is Equalizer front or Equalizer rear.
located as illustrated below. The sound level for the wavelength is
1. Set the audio system in AUX mode using
the MODE button, press MENU and navi- adjusted with / on the navigation
gate with (4) to AUX input volume, see button. Press / to select another
page 137. wavelength.
2. Turn the SOUND control or press / 2. Use ENTER to save or EXIT to close.
the navigation button, see page 137.
Sound stage
Audio controls The sound experience can be optimised for the
Press the control SOUND repeatedly to driver's seat*, both front seats or the rear seat.
browse among the following listed options. Select one of the options under
Audio settings Sound stage.
Adjustment is made by turning the control.

Subwoofer location.

2 Certain audio levels.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 139


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

Optimum sound reproduction AUX, USB and iPod the centre console's storage compartment
The audio system is calibrated for optimum (see preceding illustration).
sound reproduction by means of digital signal General
The text Loading is shown in the display when
processing. the system is loading the storage media's file
This calibration takes into account loudspeak- structure. This may take some time.
ers, amplifiers, passenger compartment Once loading is complete, track information is
acoustics, listener position etc. for each com- shown on the display and the desired track can
bination of car model and audio system. be selected.
There is a also a dynamic calibration that takes A track can be selected in three ways:
into account the position of the volume control,
04 radio reception and vehicle speed. • With the TUNING control, , see page 137.
The controls explained in these operating • the navigation control's (4) right or left-
hand button or, , see page 137.
instructions, e.g. Bass, Treble and
Equalizer, are only intended for the user to be • the steering wheel keypad (see page 137).
An iPodŸ or MP3 player can be connected to the
able to adapt the sound reproduction accord- car's infotainment system via the USB connec- In USB or iPodŸ mode the audio system oper-
ing to personal taste. tion* or AUX input in the centre console. ates in an equivalent way to the CD player play-
The AUX input enables the connection of an ing back music files. For more information, see
external audio source, e.g. an iPodŸ or MP3 page 142.
player. Read more on page 139.
NOTE
If you choose to connect an iPodŸ, MP3 player
or a USB memory stick to the USB connec- The system supports the playback of music
tion* then you can control the audio source files in the MP3, WMA and WAV file formats.
However, there are variants of these file for-
using the car's audio controls. mats that are not supported by the system.
Select the connection using the MODE button: The system also supports the majority of
iPodŸ models produced in 2005 or later.
1. If USB is selected then Connect device is iPodŸ Shuffle is not supported.
shown in the display.
2. Connect your iPodŸ, MP3 player or USB
memory stick to the USB connection* in

140 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

Audio sources iPodŸ CD functions


USB memory An iPodŸ is charged and supplied with power
To facilitate the use of a USB memory stick, by the USB connection, via the player's con-
only store music files on it. It takes a lot longer nection cable. However, if the player's battery
for the system to load storage media that con- is fully discharged then it must be charged
tains anything other than compatible music before being connected.
files.
NOTE
NOTE When an iPodŸ is used as audio source, the
car's infotainment system has a menu
The system supports removable media
which is compatible with USB 2.0 and the structure that is similar to the iPodŸ player's 04

G031443
FAT32 file system, and can handle a maxi- own menu structure.
mum of 500 folders and 64 000 files. The
memory must have a capacity of at least 256 Centre console, controls for CD functions.
For information on USB and iPodŸ in combi-
Mb. nation with Performance audio, see the acces- CD eject
sory manual for USB andiPodŸ Music CD insert and eject slot
NOTE Interface.
Fast-wind and change CD track
When using a longer model USB memory
stick the use of the enclosed USB adapter Navigation button for changing CD tracks
cable is recommended. This is to avoid
mechanical wear to the USB input and the Scan CD
connected USB memory stick.
CD changer position selection (only
applies to the High Performance and Pre-
MP3 player mium Sound audio systems)*
Many MP3 players have their own file systems
that are not supported by the audio system. For Start playback (CD player)
use in the system, an MP3 player must be set If a music CD is in the player when CD is
in USB Removable device/Mass Storage pressed then playback is started automatically.
Device mode. Otherwise, insert a disc and press CD.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 141


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

Start playback (CD changer) Audio files Fast-wind/change CD tracks and audio
Start CD playback by pressing the CD button. The CD player also supports MP3 and WMA files
If a music CD is in the player when this takes format audio files. Short presses / on the navigation button
place then playback is started automatically. are used to scroll between CD tracks/audio
Otherwise, insert a disc and press CD. NOTE files. Long presses are used to fast-wind CD
Some copy protected audio files may not be tracks/audio files. The steering wheel keypad
Insert a CD (CD changer)
read by the player. can also be used for this purpose. Track
1. Select an empty position with the number
change can also be made by turning
buttons 1–6 or / on the navigation TUNING.
button (4). When a CD with audio files is inserted into the
player the disc's file structure is loaded. Scan CD
04 An empty position is marked on the dis- Depending on the quality of the disc and the
play. The text Insert disc shows that a new This function plays the first ten seconds of
quantity of information there may be a delay each CD track/audio file. Press SCAN to acti-
disc can be inserted. The CD changer can before playback starts.
hold up to six CDs. vate. Interrupt with EXIT or SCAN to continue
Navigation and playback playback of the current CD track/audio file.
2. Insert a CD in the CD changer slot.
If a disc containing audio files is inside the CD
Random
Disc eject player then ENTER leads to the disc's direc-
This function plays the tracks in random order.
A CD will stay in the ejected position for tory structure. The directory structure is navi-
The random CD tracks/audio files can be scrol-
approx. 12 seconds. Following which it is re- gated in the same way as the audio system's
led through in the normal way.
inserted in the player and playback continues. menu structure. Audio files have the symbol
and directories have the symbol .
Eject individual discs by pressing the eject but- NOTE
Start audio file playback with ENTER.
ton. It is only possible to scroll between random
When the playback of a file is finished the play- CD tracks on the current disc.
Eject all discs with a long press on the eject
back of the other files in the same directory
button. The entire magazine is emptied disc by
continues. Directory change takes place auto-
disc. Different messages appear depending on
matically when all files in the current directory
have been played back. which random function has been selected:
Pause
If the volume is turned down completely, the
CD player is stopped. The player is restarted
when volume is increased.

142
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

• RANDOM means that the tracks from only Radio functions Tuning, manual
one music CD are played 1. Select wavelength using FM or AM.
• RND ALL means that all tracks on all 2. Turn TUNING.
music CDs in the CD changer are played.
• RANDOM FOLDER means that the audio Preset
files in a directory on the current CD are 10 station presets can be stored per wave-
played. length. FM has 2 memories for presets: FM1
CD player and FM2. The stored presets are selected
using the preset buttons.
If a normal music CD is being played, activate/
deactivate under Random. Preset storage can be carried out manually or
automatically. 04

G031441
If a disc with audio files is being played, acti-
vate/deactivate under Random Folder. Preset storage, manual
Centre console, controls for radio functions. 1. Tune into a station.
CD changer
If a normal music CD is being played under Navigation button for tuning, automatic 2. Hold in a station preset button until the
Random Single disc or Random All Cancel function in progress message Channel stored appears on the
discs. The option All discs only applies to the display.
music CDs in the changer. Tuning, manual Preset storage, automatic
If a CD with audio files is being played, activate/ Scan wavelength The function is especially useful in areas where
the radio stations and their frequencies are
deactivate instead under Random Folder.
Preset storage, automatic unfamiliar. The 10 strongest radio stations are
If you select another CD the function is deac-
stored automatically in a separate memory.
tivated. Preset buttons and preset storage, manual
1. Select wavelength using FM or AM.
Track information Select wavelength AM and FM (FM1 and
If track information is stored on a music CD FM2) 2. Hold in AUTO until Autostoring appears
then it can be shown on the display. This also on the display.
Tuning, automatic
applies to MP3 and WMA files for Premium Once Autostoring disappears from the dis-
1. Select wavelength using FM or AM.
Sound and High Performance. Activate/deac- play, the stations are stored. The radio contin-
tivate in CD mode under CD settings Track 2. Press / on the navigation button. ues in Auto mode and Auto appears on the
information. display. The automatically stored presets can

``

143
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

now be selected using the preset buttons. • Automatically switches to a stronger trans- Alarm
Automatic preset storage can be cancelled mitter if reception in the area is poor. This function is used to warn of serious acci-
using EXIT. • Searches for programme type, such as dents and catastrophes. The alarm cannot be
Auto mode is cancelled by pressing for exam- traffic information or news. temporarily interrupted or deactivated. The
ple AUTO or FM. • Receives text information on current radio message ALARM! appears on the display
programme. when an alarm message is transmitted.
Returning to Auto mode provides access to the
autostored presets: Traffic information – TP
NOTE This function allows traffic information sent
1. Press AUTO.
Some radio stations do not use RDS or only within a set station's RDS network to break
> Auto appears on the display. some if its functionality. through. The TP (Traffic information) symbol
04 indicates that the function is activated. If the
2. Press a preset button.
If a required programme type is located the set station can send traffic information then
Scan wavelength radio can switch stations interrupting the audio appears on the display.
The function automatically searches the cur- source currently in use. For example, if the CD
rent wavelength for strong stations. When a ± Activate/deactivate under FM settings
player is in use, it is paused. The interrupting
station is found, it is played for approx. 8 sec- TP (Traffic information).
transmission is played at a preset volume, see
onds before scanning is resumed. page 146. The radio returns to the previous TP from current station/all stations
1. Select wavelength using AM or FM. audio source and volume when the set pro- The radio can interrupt with traffic information
gramme type is no longer broadcast. from only the set (current) station or from all
2. Press SCAN.
The programme functions alarm (ALARM!), stations.
SCAN appears on the display. Close using
traffic information (TP (Traffic information)), ± Go to FM settings Advanced radio
SCAN or EXIT.
news (News), and programme types (PTY
settings TP Station... to change.
RDS functions (Program type)) interrupt one another in order
RDS (Radio Data System) links FM transmitters of priority, where alarm has the highest priority News
into a network. An FM transmitter in such a and programme types has the lowest. For fur-
This function allows news broadcasts sent
network sends information that gives an RDS ther programme interruption settings (EON within a set station's RDS network to break
radio the following functions: and Regional), see page 145. Press EXIT to through. The NEWS symbol indicates that the
return to the interrupted audio source. function is active.

144
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

± Activate/deactivate under FM settings 2. Go to FM settings Automatic frequency update – AF


News. PTY (Program type) Search PTY. This function selects one of the strongest
transmitters for a set station. The function may
News from current/all stations If the radio finds any of the selected pro- need to search through the entire FM wave-
The radio can interrupt with news from only the gramme types, >| To seek appears on the dis- length to find a strong transmitter. If this
set (current) station or from all stations. play. occurs, the radio mutes and PI Seek Press
± Go to FM settings Advanced radio ± To continue searching for another broad- Exit to cancel appears on the display.
settings News station... to change. cast of the selected programme types, ± Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM
press on the navigation button. settings Advanced radio settings
Programme types – PTY AF.
The PTY function can be used to select differ- Display of programme type 04
ent programme types, such as pop music and The programme type of the current station can Regional radio programmes – REG
serious classic. The PTY symbol indicates that be shown on the display. This function causes the radio to continue with
the function is active. This function allows pro- ± Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM a regional transmitter even if its signal strength
gramme types broadcast within a set station's settings PTY Show PTY is low. The symbol REG shows that the func-
RDS network to break through. tion is active.
1. Activate in FM mode by selecting a pro- NOTE ± Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM
gramme type under FM settings PTY Not all radio stations support display of pro- settings Advanced radio settings
Select PTY. gramme type. Regional.
2. Deactivate by clearing the PTY under FM Enhanced Other Networks – EON
settings Clear all PTY. Radio text This function is useful in urban areas with many
Some RDS stations transmit information on regional radio stations. It allows the distance
PTY search programme content, artists, etc. This informa- between the car and the radio station trans-
This function searches the entire wavelength tion can be shown on the display. mitter to determine when programme functions
for the selected programme type. ± should interrupt the current audio source.
Activate/deactivate in FM mode under
1. Select a PTY under FM settings PTY Radio text. ± Activate/deactivate in FM mode by select-
Select PTY. ing one of the options under FM settings
Advanced radio settings EON:

``

145
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

• Local – interrupts only if the radio station Menu structure FM Classical


transmitter is close.
Main menu FM Other music
• Distant3 – interrupts if the station trans- FM settings
mitter is far away, even if there is a lot of Weather & metro
static. 1.1 News Finance
• Off – no interruption for programmes from 1.2 TP (Traffic information) Children's programs
other transmitters.
1.3 Radio text Social affairs
Resetting RDS functions 1.4 PTY (Program type) Religion
All radio settings can be reset to the original
factory settings. 1.4.1 Select PTY Phone in
04
± The reset is carried out in FM mode under Clear all PTY Travel & touring
FM settings Advanced radio settings Current affairs Leisure & hobby
Reset all. Information Jazz music
Volume control, programme types Sport Country music
The interrupting programme types, e.g. Education National music
NEWS or TP, are heard at the volume selected
for each respective programme type. If the vol- Drama Oldies music
ume level is adjusted during the programme Culture Folk music
interruption, the new level is saved until the
next programme interruption. Science Documentary
Varied speech 1.4.2 Search PTY
Pop music 1.4.3 Show PTY text
Rock music 1.5. Advanced radio settings
Easy listening 1.5.1 TP station
Light classic 1.5.2 News station

3 Factory settings.

146
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

1.5.3 AF Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) • Ensemble - Shows channel groups that
When the vehicle is moved to a new broad- the receiver has obtained via channel
1.5.4 EON
casting area, programming of existing channel group programming.
Off groups in the area can take place. • Service - Shows channels irrespective of
Local Programming of channel groups creates an the channel group to which they are allo-
updated list of all available channel groups. cated. The list can also be filtered using
Distant DAB PTY (see below).
The list is not updated automatically. Program-
1.5.5 Regional ming takes place via the Ensemble learn • Subchannel - Subchannels to a selected
1.5.6 Reset FM sett. menu or directly by means of a long press on channel.
AUTO. If can take up to a minute to program a The lists can be accessed via the menu. The
channel group if both Band III and LBand are channel groups can also be accessed by 04
Radio system - DAB* selected. pressing ENTER.
General Wavelength Scanning
DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) is a digital DAB is transmitted on two wavelengths4; Band Scanning means that all channels in the list are
broadcasting system for radio. III and LBand. played for 10 seconds each.

NOTE
• Band III – over the whole country5 ± Press SCAN to activate
• LBand - mainly in large cities Scanning can also be selected in DAB-PTY
This system does not support DAB+.
By selecting for example Band III on its own, mode. In which case only channels of the pre-
channel programming takes place more selected programme type are played.
Service and Ensemble quickly than if both Band III and LBand are ± Stop scanning by pressing SCAN once, or
• Service - Channel, radio channel (only selected. It is not certain that all channel by pressing EXIT.
audio services are supported by the sys- groups will be found. Wavelength selection
tem). does not affect the stored memories. Subchannel
• Ensemble - A collection of radio channels Secondary components are usually named
on the same frequency. Navigation via lists subchannels. These are temporary and can
There are three types of basic list which can be contain e.g. translations of the main pro-
used for navigation: gramme into other languages.

4 Not all areas/countries use both wavelengths.


5 During a build-up phase DAB will not cover the whole country but will only work in larger urban areas.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 147


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

If one or more subchannels are broadcast then DAB to DAB link channel will be played. The preset is not
the > symbol is shown to the right of the chan- It is possible to exit a channel with poor or no dependent on the channel list.
nel name in the display. A subchannel is indi- reception to the same channel in another chan- A saved channel does not have to be in the
cated by the > symbol appearing to the left of nel group with better reception. There may be channel list for it to be playable. If the channel
the channel name in the display. a certain delay when changing channel group. is loaded when it is not available then a preset
To access a subchannel: There may be a period of silence between the number is shown and there is silence until an
current channel no longer being available to the available preset is selected for loading. Alter-
± Press new channel becoming available. natively another channel.
To navigate between subchannels: DAB display settings
± 1. Basic - Only the channel name is shown if NOTE
Press or
04 a primary component is being played. A The audio system's DAB system does not
Subchannels can only be accessed on the subchannel name is shown if it is a sub- support all functions available in the DAB
selected main channel and not on any other channel being played standard.
one without selecting it.
2. Ensemble - Adds the channel group name
DAB PTY (program type) to the channel name Menu structure DAB
DAB PTY selects one type of radio pro- 3. Ensemble +PTY - Adds the programme Main menu DAB
gramme. There are 29 different programme type name under the channel name
types which also include different programme 1. Select ensemble
categories. After selecting a programme type, Preset 2. Select service
navigation only takes place within the channels 10 station presets can be stored per wave-
broadcasting that type. length. DAB has 2 memories for presets: 3. Select subchannel

Exit this mode as follows: DAB1 and DAB2. The stored presets are 4. DAB PTY
selected using the preset buttons.
± Press EXIT 4.1. DAB PTY off
A preset contains one channel but no sub-
It is also possible to select a preset channel or 4.2. News
channels. If a subchannel is being played and
exit DAB PTY via the menu. In certain cases a preset is saved then only the channel ID is 4.3. Current affairs
DAB radio will exit PTY mode when DAB to registered. This is because subchannels are 4.4. Information
DAB linking (see below) is implemented. temporary. At the next attempt to retrieve the
preset, the channel which contained the sub- 4.5. Sport

148
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Audio system

4.6. Education 4.28. Oldies music


4.7. Drama 4.29. Folk music
4.8. Culture 4.30. Documentary
4.9. Science 5. Ensemble learn
4.10. Varied speech 6. DAB settings
4.11. Pop music 6.1. DAB display settings
4.12 Rock music 6.1.1. Ensemble name
4.13. Calm music 6.1.2. Ensemble name and
04
PTY
4.14. Light classic
6.1.3. Basic
4.15. Serious classic
6.2. DAB to DAB link
4.16. Other music
6.3. FM traffic
4.17. Weather & metro
6.4. Select DAB band
4.18. Finance
6.4.1. Band III
4.19 Children
6.4.2. LBand
4.20. Factual
6.4.3. LBand & Band III
4.21. Religion
6.5. Reset DAB
4.22. Phone in
4.23. Travel & touring
4.24. Leisure & hobby
4.25. Jazz and blues
4.26. Country music
4.27. National music

149
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

General Functions NOTE


There may be a slight error in the reading if
NOTE a fuel-driven additional1 and/or parking
If a warning message appears while you are heater* has been used.
using the trip computer, this message must
be acknowledged in order to revert to the
trip computer function. Acknowledge by Km to empty tank
pressing READ. The calculation is based on the average fuel
consumption over the last 30 km and the
remaining driveable fuel quantity. The display
To change unit indication for distance and
shows the approximate distance that can be
04 speed, contact a workshop. Volvo recom-
driven with the fuel quantity remaining in the

G021364
mends that you seek assistance from an
tank.
authorised Volvo workshop.
Information display and controls. An economic driving style generally results in a
READ - confirms Average speed longer driving distance. For more information
The car calculates the average speed from the on how you can influence fuel consumption,
Thumbwheel – browse between menus last resetting. Reset using RESET. see page 11
and options in the trip computer list
Instantaneous No guaranteed range remains when the display
RESET – resets shows "--- km to empty tank". Refuel as soon
Current fuel consumption is calculated every
To scroll through trip computer information, second. The information on the display is as possible.
turn the thumbwheel up or down in steps. Con- updated every couple of seconds. When the
tinue turning to return to the starting point. car is stationary, "----" appears on the display. NOTE
Average There may be a slight error in the reading if
the driving style has been changed.
The average fuel consumption since the last
reset. Reset using RESET.
Resetting
1. Select Average speed or Average.

1 Diesel cars only.

150 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

2. Press and hold RESET for


approx. 1 second to reset the selected
function. If RESET is kept depressed for at
least 3 three seconds then Average speed
and Average are reset simultaneously.

Current speed*
The instrument panel display shows current
speed in mph if the speedometer is graduated
in km/h. If the speedometer is graduated in
mph then the current speed is shown in km/h.
04

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 151


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

DSTC – Stability and traction control system

General information on DSTC Operation The system remains reduced until the engine is
The stability and traction control system, DSTC next started.
Reduced operation
(Dynamic Stability and Traction Control), helps
System operation during skidding and accel- WARNING
the driver to avoid skidding and improves the
eration can be reduced. Operation during skid-
car's traction. The car's driving characteristics may dete-
ding is delayed and so allows more skidding
The activation of the system during braking which provides greater freedom for dynamic riorate if the function is reduced.
may be noticed as a throbbing sound. The car driving. Traction in deep snow or sand is
may accelerate slower than expected when the improved as traction is no longer limited. Messages in the information display
accelerator pedal is depressed.
DSTC Temporarily OFF
04 Active Yaw Control System temporarily reduced due to excessive
The function limits the driving and brake force brake disc temperature. The function is reacti-
of the wheels individually in order to stabilise vated automatically when the brakes have
the car. cooled.
DSTC Service required
Spin Control
System disabled due to a fault.
The function prevents the driving wheels from
spinning against the road surface during accel- Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
eration. engine. If the message remains when the

G021409
engine is restarted, drive to a workshop - an
Traction control system authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
The function is active at low speed and trans-
fers power from the driving wheel that is spin- 1. Turn the thumbwheel until the DSTC Symbols in the combined instrument
ning to the one that is not. menu is shown. DSTC ON means that the panel
system function is unchanged. If the symbols and are displayed
DSTC spin control OFF means that sys- at the same time, read the message on the
tem operation is reduced. information display.

2. Press and hold RESET until the DSTC If the symbol appears alone then it may
menu is changed. appear as follows:

152
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

DSTC – Stability and traction control system

• Flashing light means that the system is


now being activated.
• Constant glow for 2 seconds means sys-
tem check when the engine is started.
• Constant glow after starting the engine or
while driving means system fault.

04

153
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adapting driving characteristics

Active chassis (Four C)* Operation For a description of the menu system, see
Active chassis, Four-C (Continously Controlled page 120. This menu cannot be accessed
Chassis Concept), regulates the characteris- while the car is in motion.
tics of the shock absorbers so that the car's
driving characteristics can be adjusted. There
are three settings: Comfort, Sport and
Advanced.

Comfort
This setting means that the car is perceived as
being more comfortable and is recommended
04
for longer journeys. Shock absorption is soft
and the movement of the body is smooth and
gentle. Chassis settings.

Sport Use the buttons in the centre console to


This setting means that the car is perceived as change setting. The setting in use when the
being more sporty and is recommended for engine is switched off is activated next time the
more active driving. Steering response is faster engine is started.
than in the Comfort mode. Shock absorption is
harder and the body follows the road in order Speed related power steering*
to reduce rolling during fast cornering. Steering force increases with the speed of the
Advanced car to give the driver enhanced sensitivity. The
This setting is only recommended on very even steering is firmer and more immediate on
and smooth road surfaces. motorways. Steering is light and requires no
extra effort when parking and at low speed.
The shock absorbers are optimised for maxi-
mum roadholding and rolling in bends is further Steering force can be set in three levels so that
minimised. you can select the level that suits you in terms
of road responsiveness or steering sensitivity.
Go to Car settings Steering force level in
the menu system.

154 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Cruise control*

Operation Cruise control is then activated with or Temporary deactivation


after which the current speed is stored and is Press On to disengage cruise control tem-
used as the set speed. The display text porarily. The saved speed is shown in brackets
(---) km/h changes to show the set speed, e.g. in the display, e.g. (100) km/h.
100 km/h.
Automatic temporary deactivation
NOTE Cruise control is deactivated spontaneously
when the driving wheels spin heavily or if the
Cruise control cannot be engaged at car's speed falls below approx. 30 km/h.
speeds below 30 km/h.
Cruise control is also deactivated when the
brakes are used, when the gear selector is 04

G021411
Adjusting the set speed moved to neutral position or if the driver main-
In active mode the speed is adjusted with long tains a speed faster than the set speed for
Display and controls. or short presses on or . longer than 1 minute.
Standby mode A temporary increase in speed using the accel- After deactivation cruise control changes over
Resume set speed erator, such as while overtaking, does not to standby mode and the set speed is saved.
affect the cruise control setting. When the
Deactivating accelerator is released the car will return to the Resume set speed
set speed. If cruise control has been deactivated tempo-
Activate/set speed rarily, it can be reactivated by pressing . The
Set speed (in brackets = standby mode) NOTE speed is then set to the previously set speed.
If one of the cruise control buttons is kept
Activating and setting the speed depressed for more than approx. one NOTE
In order to enable the activation of cruise con- minute then cruise control is disengaged. A significant increase in speed may arise
trol, it must first be engaged in standby mode The engine must then be switched off in
order to then reset cruise control. after the speed has been resumed with .
with the CRUISE button . The symbol
illuminates in the display and the text (---) km/
h shows that cruise control is in standby Deactivation
mode. Cruise control is disengaged with CRUISE or
by switching off the engine. The set speed is
cleared.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 155


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

General Function WARNING


Adaptive Cruise Control – (ACC) is designed to
Adaptive cruise control is not a collision
assist the driver with support on long straight avoidance system. The driver must inter-
roads in steady traffic, for example on motor- vene if the system does not detect a vehicle
ways and main roads. in front.
Adaptive cruise control does not brake for
WARNING people or animals. Nor for oncoming, slow
You must always pay attention to the traffic or stationary vehicles and objects.
conditions and intervene when adaptive Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for
cruise control is not maintaining a suitable example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at
04 speed or suitable distance. junctions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of
Adaptive cruise control cannot cover all water or slush on the road, in heavy rain/
driving situations and traffic, weather and snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or
road conditions. Functions overview. on slip roads.

The Function section and after informs Warning lamp, braking by driver required
about limitations that the driver must be The distance to the vehicle ahead is measured
Controls by a radar sensor. The speed is regulated by
aware of before using the adaptive cruise
control. Radar sensor acceleration and braking. It is normal for the
When driving you are responsible for main- brakes to emit a low sound when they are being
Adaptive cruise control consists of a cruise used by cruise control.
taining the correct distance and speed,
even when adaptive cruise control is used. control system and a coordinated spacing sys-
tem. WARNING
IMPORTANT The brake pedal moves when the cruise
control brakes. Do not rest your foot under
Maintenance of adaptive cruise control the brake pedal as it could become trapped.
components must only be performed at a
workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop
is recommended. The cruise control objective is to follow the
vehicle ahead but in the same lane and at a set
time interval. If the radar sensor has not
detected a vehicle ahead then the only objec-

156 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

tive is the set speed. This is also the case if the NOTE Set time interval
speed of the vehicle ahead exceeds the cruise
control set speed. The warning lamp may be difficult to notice Activating and setting the speed
in strong sunlight or when sunglasses are
The adaptive cruise control aims to control the being worn. Set speed (in brackets = standby mode)
speed in a smooth way. In situations that Set time interval during adjustment
demand sudden braking you must brake your-
self. This applies with large differences in WARNING Set time interval after adjustment
speed, or if the vehicle in front brakes heavily. Cruise control only warns of vehicles
Due to limitations in the radar sensor, braking detected by the radar sensor. Consequently Activating and setting the speed
may come unexpectedly or not at all, see there may be no warning or it may be sub- In order to enable the activation of cruise con-
page 159. ject to a delay. Do not wait for a warning but trol, it must first be engaged in standby mode 04
brake when it is necessary.
Adaptive cruise control can only be activated with the button . The symbol illuminates
above 30 km/h. If speed falls below 30 km/h or in the display and the characters (---) show
if engine speed becomes too slow, then the Operation that cruise control is in standby mode.
adaptive cruise control disengages and stops
Cruise control is then activated with or ,
braking. In which case the driver must imme-
after which the current speed is stored and is
diately take over and maintain the distance to
used as the set speed. The display characters
vehicles in front. The highest speed setting is
(---) change to show the set speed, e.g. 100.
200 km/h.
The car symbol is illuminated
Warning lamp, braking by driver required on the left-hand side of the
Adaptive cruise control has a braking capacity display when the radar sensor
that is equivalent to approximately 30% of the has detected another vehicle.
car's braking capacity. The distance to vehicles in
If the car needs to brake more heavily than front is only regulated when
cruise control capacity and the driver does not the symbol is illuminated.
brake, then the cruise control uses the collision Display and controls.
warning system's warning lamp and warning Activate and resume settings, increase NOTE
sound to alert the driver that immediate inter- speed Cruise control cannot be engaged at
vention is required. speeds below 30 km/h.
Standby mode, on/off

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 157


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Adjusting the set speed At low speed, when the distances are short, the Deactivating and resuming settings
In active mode the speed is adjusted with long adaptive cruise control increases the time Cruise control is deactivated, either with a
or short presses on , or . In active interval slightly. short press on , or by means of driver inter-
mode the button has the same function as The adaptive cruise control allows the time vention, e.g. braking. The set speed is then
but results in a lower increase in speed. interval to vary noticeably in certain situations shown in brackets, e.g. (100). Speed and time
in order to allow the car to follow the vehicle in interval are resumed with one press on .
front smoothly and comfortably.
NOTE For each additional press on , when cruise
If one of the cruise control buttons is kept Note that a short time interval only allows the control is activated, the set speed increases in
depressed for more than approx. one driver a short reaction time if any unforeseen stages of 1 km/h.
minute then cruise control is disengaged. traffic problem should arise.
04 The engine must then be switched off in The number of lines for the NOTE
order to then reset cruise control.
selected time interval is
In some situations cruise control cannot be A significant increase in speed may arise
shown during the setting itself
activated. In which case Cruise control after the speed has been resumed with .
and for several seconds after-
Unavailable is shown in the display, see wards. Then a smaller scale
page 160. A short press on in standby mode or a long
version of the symbol is
shown to the right of the dis- press in active mode deactivates cruise con-
Set time interval play. The same symbol is also shown when trol. The set speed is cleared and cannot be
The set time interval to vehicles in front is Distance Alert is activated, see page 162. resumed.
increased with and decreased with .
NOTE Deactivation due to driver intervention
Five different time intervals Cruise control is deactivated when the brakes
can be chosen from and Only use the time interval that is allowed in are used, the gear selector is moved to neutral
shown in the display as 1–5 accordance with local traffic regulations. position, or if the accelerator pedal is
horizontal lines – the more If cruise control does not seem to react to depressed for a longer period. Cruise control
lines there are the longer the activation the reason may be that the time then changes over to standby mode and the
time interval, see page 162 interval to the closest vehicle prevents an driver must regulate vehicle speed manually.
for table. increase in speed.
If the accelerator pedal is kept depressed for a
The higher the speed, the longer the calcu-
lated distance in metres for a specific time shorter period, for example during overtaking,
interval. cruise control is temporarily disengaged and

158 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

then re-engaged when the accelerator pedal is Modification of the radar sensor could result in
released. it being illegal to use.

Automatic deactivation WARNING


Adaptive cruise control is dependent on other
systems e.g. stability and traction control sys- Accessories or other objects such as auxil-
tem (DSTC). If any of these systems stop work- iary lamps must not be installed in front of
ing then cruise control is automatically deacti- the grille.
vated.
The capacity of the radar sensor to detect vehi-
In the event of automatic deactivation a signal
cles in front is reduced significantly:
will sound and the message Cruise control 04
Cancelled is shown in the display. The driver • if the radar sensor becomes blocked and
must then intervene and adapt the speed to cannot detect other vehicles e.g. in heavy
vehicles in front. rain or slush, or if other objects have col-
lected in front of the radar sensor.
An automatic deactivation can be due to:
• speed falls below 30 km/h NOTE
• wheels lose traction Keep the surface in front of the radar sensor
clean.

G021414
• brake temperature is high
• engine speed is too low
• the radar sensor is covered e.g. by wet • if the speed of vehicles in front is signifi- Radar sensor field of vision (grey).
cantly different from your own speed.
snow or heavy rain (radar waves blocked). Sometimes the radar sensor cannot detect
The radar sensor has a limited field of vision. In vehicles at close quarters, for example a
some situations it may detect another vehicle vehicle that drives in between your car and
The radar sensor and its limitations later than expected or not detect any vehicle at vehicles in front.
Apart from the adaptive cruise control, the all.
radar sensor is also used by the Collision Small vehicles, such as motorcycles, or
Warning with Auto Brake function (see vehicles not driving in the centre of the lane
page 170) and the Distance Alert function (see can remain undetected.
page 162). It is designed to detect cars or
larger vehicles driving in the same direction.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 159


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

In bends the radar sensor may detect the radar signals from the radar sensor are blocked with Auto Brake functions are not operating
wrong vehicle or lose a detected vehicle and that vehicles in front of the car could not either.
from view. be detected.
The table presents possible causes for a mes-
Fault tracing and action In turn this means that the Adaptive Cruise sage being shown along with the appropriate
If the display shows the message Radar Control, Distance Alert and Collision Warning action.
blocked See manual this means that the

Cause Action

04 The radar surface in the grille is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the radar surface in the grille from dirt, ice and snow.

Heavy rain or snow blocking the radar signals. No action. Sometimes the radar does not work during heavy rain or
snowfall.

Water or snow from the road surface swirls up and blocks the radar sig- No action. Sometimes the radar does not work on a very wet or snowy
nals. road surface.

The radar surface has been cleaned but the message remains. Wait. It could take several minutes for the radar to sense that it is no
longer blocked.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Standby mode or active mode without detected vehicle.

Active mode with detected vehicle to which cruise control adapts the speed.

Set time interval, during adjustment.

160 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Symbol Message Specification


Set time interval, after adjustment.

Turn on DSTC Cruise control cannot be activated until the traction control and stability function (DSTC) has been
activated.
to enable Cruise

Cruise control The cruise control has been shut down.


Cancelled The driver must regulate the speed.

Cruise control Cruise control cannot be activated. 04

Unavailable This could be due to:


• brake temperature is high
• the radar sensor is blocked e.g. by wet snow or rain.

Radar blocked Cruise control temporarily disengaged.


See manual The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles, e.g. in the event that heavy rain or slush
has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor, see page 159.

Cruise control Cruise control not working.


Service required Contact with an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 161


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert

General Distance Alert is active at speeds above Five different time intervals
Distance Alert is a function that indicates the 30 km/h. can be chosen from and
time interval to vehicles in front. shown in the display as 1–5
WARNING horizontal lines – the more
The distance information is only provided for lines there are the longer the
vehicles driving in front of the car and in the Distance Alert only shows the distance to time interval.
same direction. No distance information is pro- vehicles in front – the speed of the car is not
vided for oncoming, slow or stationary vehi- affected.
cles. Number of lines Time interval
(seconds)
Operation
1 1.0
04
2 1.4

3 1.8

4 2.2

5 2.6

The number of lines for the


selected time interval is
shown during the setting itself
A small section of the red warning lamp in the and for several seconds after-
windscreen illuminates with a constant glow Press the button in the centre console to switch wards. Then a smaller scale
when driving closer than the set time interval to the function on or off. The function is switched version of the symbol is
vehicles in front. on if one lamp is illuminated in the button. shown to the right of the dis-
play. The same symbol is also shown when
NOTE Set time interval adaptive cruise control is activated.
The buttons for setting the time interval to vehi-
Distance Alert is deactivated during the time
cles in front are located to the left in the steer-
that Adaptive Cruise Control is active.
ing wheel. Time intervals are increased using
and decreased using .

162
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert

NOTE ing system. For more information on the radar


sensor and its limitations, see page 159.
The higher the speed, the longer the calcu-
lated distance in metres for a specific time
interval. NOTE
The set time interval is also used by the Strong sunlight, reflections or strong varia-
adaptive cruise control function, see tions in light intensity, as well as wearing
page 157. sunglasses, could mean that the warning
light in the windscreen cannot be seen.
Only use the time interval that is allowed in
accordance with local traffic regulations.
Poor weather or winding roads could affect the
radar sensor's capacity to detect vehicles in 04
Limitations front. The size of other vehicles could also
The function uses the same radar sensor as affect detection capacity, e.g. motorcycles.
adaptive cruise control and the collision warn- This could mean that the warning lamp illumi-
nates at a shorter distance than the setting or
that the warning is temporarily absent.
Extremely high speeds can also cause the
lamp to illuminate at a shorter distance than
that set due to limitations in sensor range.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Set time interval, during adjustment.

Set time interval, after adjustment.

``

163
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert

Symbol Message Specification


Radar blocked. Distance Alert temporarily disengaged.
See manual The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles, e.g. in the event that heavy rain or slush
has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor see page 159

Collision warn. Service Distance Alert or Collision Warning with Auto Brake is fully or partially disengaged.
required Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
04

164
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

General If the car is also equipped with a Collision Function


City Safety™ is a function for helping the driver Warning function with Auto Brake*, these two
to avoid a collision when driving in queues, systems complement each other. For more
amongst other things, when changes in the information on Collision Warning function with
traffic ahead, combined with a lapse in atten- Auto Brake, see page 170.
tion, could lead to an incident.
IMPORTANT
The function is active at speeds of up to
30 km/h and it helps the driver by automatically Maintenance and replacement of City
braking the car in the event of imminent risk of Safety™ components must only be per-
collision with vehicles in front, should the driver formed by a workshop - an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended. 04
not react in time by braking and/or steering
away.
City Safety™ is activated in situations where WARNING
Laser sensor transmitter and receiver window.
the driver should have started braking earlier, City Safety™ does not engage in all driving
City Safety™ detects the traffic in front of the
which is why is cannot help the driver in every situations or traffic, weather or road condi-
tions. car with a laser sensor fitted in the top edge of
situation.
the windscreen. If there is an imminent risk of
City Safety™ is designed to be activated as City Safety™ does not react to vehicles collision, City Safety™ will automatically brake
late as possible in order to avoid unnecessary driving in a different direction from the car,
the car with approx. 50% of maximum brake
to small vehicles, motorcycles and bicycles
intervention. force.
or to humans and animals.
City Safety™ must not be used as an excuse City Safety™ can prevent collision at a If the speed difference is 4-15 km/h in relation
for the driver to change his/her driving style. If speed difference of less than 15 km/h - at a to the vehicle in front then City Safety™ can
the driver solely relies on City Safety™ to do higher speed difference, it is only possible completely prevent a collision.
the braking, there will be a collision sooner or to reduce collision speed. In order to obtain
full brake function, the driver must depress City Safety™ activates a short, sharp braking
later.
the brake pedal. and stops the car in normal circumstances, just
The driver or passengers normally only notice behind the vehicle in front. For most drivers this
City Safety™ if a situation arises where the car Never wait for City Safety™ to engage. The
driver always bears responsibility for main-
is well outside normal driving style and may be
is extremely close to being in a collision. experienced as being uncomfortable.
taining the proper distance and speed.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 165


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

If the difference in speed between the vehicles WARNING


is 15-30 km/h, City Safety™ may not prevent
the collision on its own. To obtain full brake The laser sensor also transmits laser light
force, the driver must depress the brake pedal. when City Safety™ is disabled manually.
This could make it possible to prevent a colli-
sion even at speed differences above To enable City Safety™ again:
15 km/h.
• Follow the same procedure as for disa-
When the function is activated and brakes, the bling, but select the On option with the
instrument panel display shows a message to RESET button.
the effect that the function is/has been active. or

G021409
04
• Switch off the engine and take out the
NOTE remote control key to position 0, then re-
Display and direction indicator stalk.
The brake lights come on when City Thumbwheel insert it to position II and start the engine -
Safety™ brakes the car. by which means City Safety™ is re-ena-
RESET button bled (see page 73 on key positions).

Operation With the engine running City Safety™ can be


disabled as follows: Limitations
The sensor in City Safety™ is designed to
NOTE 1. Use the thumbwheel to scroll to City
detect cars and other large vehicles in front of
Safety on the display.
The City Safety™ function is always ena- the car irrespective of whether it is day or night.
bled after the engine has been started via 2. Hold the RESET button depressed for 1
key position I and II (see page 73 on key second to switch to Off. However, the sensor has limitations and has
positions). poorer functionality in e.g. heavy snowfall or
However, the function will be enabled the next
rain, dense fog, dust storms or snow flurries.
time the engine is started, regardless of
Mist, dirt, ice or snow on the windscreen may
On and Off whether the system was enabled or disabled
disrupt the function.
In certain situations, it may advisable to disable when the engine was switched off.
City Safety™, e.g. for driving off-road where Low-hanging objects, e.g. a flag/pennant for
leafy branches could sweep over the bonnet/ projecting load, or accessories such as auxili-
windscreen or similar. ary lamps and bull bars that are higher than the
bonnet limit the function.

166
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

The infrared light from the sensor in City then speed is reduced to the same speed as The following table presents possible causes
Safety™ measures how the light is reflected. that maintained by the vehicle in front. for the message being shown, along with sug-
The sensor cannot detect objects with low gestions for appropriate action.
On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops
reflection capacity. The rear sections of the
when City Safety™ has stopped the car, unless
vehicle generally reflect the light sufficiently Cause Action
the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal
thanks to the number plate and rear light reflec-
beforehand.
tors. The windscreen sur- Clean the wind-
NOTE face in front of the screen surface in
On slippery road surfaces the braking distance
laser sensor is dirty front of the sensor
is extended, which may reduce the capacity of • Keep the windscreen surface in front of or covered with ice from dirt, ice and
City Safety™ to avoid a collision. In such sit- the laser sensor free from ice, snow and or snow. snow.
uations the ABS and DSTC systems will pro- dirt (see the illustration for sensor loca- 04
vide best possible braking force with main- tion, page 165). The laser sensor Remove the block-
tained stability. • Do not affix or mount anything on the field of vision is ing object.
When the car is reversing City Safety™ cannot windscreen in front of the laser sensor blocked.
be activated. • Remove ice and snow from the bonnet
City Safety™ is not activated at low speeds - - snow and ice must not exceed a height
under 4 km/h, which is why the system does of 5 cm.
not intervene in situations where a vehicle in
front is being approached very slowly, e.g. Fault tracing and action
when parking. If the message Windscreen Sensors
Driver commands are always prioritised, which blocked is shown on the instrument panel dis-
is why City Safety™ does not intervene in sit- play, it indicates that the laser sensor is
uations where the driver is steering, braking or blocked and cannot detect vehicles in front of
accelerating in a clear manner, even if a colli- the car. This means that City Safety™ is not
sion is unavoidable. operational.

When City Safety™ has prevented a collision The Windscreen Sensors blocked message
with a stationary object the car remains sta- is not shown for all situations in which the laser
tionary for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car sensor is blocked. The driver must therefore be
is braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, diligent about keeping the windscreen and
area in front of the laser sensor clean.

``

167
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

IMPORTANT Laser sensor Symbols and messages in the display


The City Safety™ function includes a sensor In conjunction with automatic braking by the
If there are cracks, scratches or stone chips
in the windscreen in front of either of the which transmits laser light. It is absolutely City Safety™ system, one or more symbols
laser sensor's "windows" and they cover a essential to follow the prescribed instructions may illuminate on the instrument panel and a
surface of approx. 0.5 × 3.0 mm (or larger), when handling the laser sensor. message may appear on its display.
then a workshop must be contacted for
A text message can be acknowledged by
repair or replacement of the windscreen WARNING
(see the illustration for sensor location, page briefly pressing the READ button on the direc-
165) - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec- Never look into the laser sensor (which tion indicator stalk.
ommended. Failure to take action may emits spreading invisible laser radiation) at
result in reduced performance for City a distance of 100 mm or closer with magni-
04 Safety™. fying optics such as a magnifying glass,
microscope, lens or similar optical instru-
To avoid the risk of reducing City Safety™ ments - this would involve a risk of eye injury
performance the following also applies: (the illustration on page 165 shows sensor
• The same type or a Volvo-approved location).
windscreen must be fitted during
replacement For more information on the laser sensor, see
• The same type or Volvo-approved page 8.
windscreen wipers must be fitted during
replacement.

168
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

Symbol Message Meaning/Action


Auto braking by City Safety City Safety™ is braking or has automatically braked.

Windscreen Sensors The laser sensor is temporarily non-operational because something is blocking it.
blocked
• Remove the object blocking the sensor and/or clean the windscreen in front of the sensor.
Read about the limitations of the laser sensor, see page 166. 04

City Safety Service City Safety™ is not operational.


required
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

City Safety ON/OFF City Safety™ can be manually disabled/enabled, whereby OFF or ON is selected, see section "On/
Off".

City Safety Unavailable If the text Unavailable is shown instead of Off or On, City Safety™ is switched off due to a technical
fault.
City Safety Service required is shown in the instrument panel display prior to this.

169
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake*

General WARNING Function


Collision Warning with Auto Brake is designed
The collision warning system does not work
to assist the driver when there is a risk of col- in all driving situations and traffic, weather
liding with a vehicle in front that is stationary or and road conditions. The collision warning
driving in the same direction. system does not react to vehicles driving in
another direction to the car or to people and
The collision warning system has the following
animals.
three functions.
Warning only activated in the event of a high
• Collision warning warns the driver of a risk for collision. The Function section and
potentially imminent collision. the section after advise about limitations of
• Brake support assists the driver to brake which the driver should be aware before
04
effectively in a critical situation. using Collision Warning with Auto Brake.

• Auto Brake brakes the car automatically The Auto Brake function can only reduce the
when a collision is unavoidable. The Auto collision speed. The driver must depress the Functions overview.
Brake function cannot prevent a collision brake pedal to achieve full brake function.
Visual warning signal in the event of a col-
but instead aims to reduce collision speed. Never wait for a collision warning. When lision risk
driving you are responsible for maintaining
IMPORTANT the correct distance and speed, even when Radar sensor
Maintenance of collision warning system the collision warning system is used.
Camera sensor
components must only be performed at a
workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop Collision warning
is recommended.
Together with a camera sensor, the radar sen-
sor detects stationary vehicles as well as vehi-
cles driving in the same direction in front of the
car. In the event of there being a risk of collision
with such a vehicle your attention is drawn with
a red flashing warning lamp and a warning
sound.
The collision warning system is active from and
including 7 km/h.

170 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake*

Brake support On and Off uations, then change to warning distance


If the risk of collision still increases after the To select whether the collision warning system Normal.
collision warning then the brake support is acti- should be switched on or off: Under the Car Only use warning distance Short in excep-
vated. The brake support prepares the brake settings Collision warning settings menu, tional cases, e.g. for dynamic driving.
system for rapid braking and the brakes are select between the options for On or Off. The
applied gently, which may be noticed as a setting selected when the engine was switched
slight jerk.
NOTE
off is automatically obtained when the engine
is started. When the adaptive cruise control is in use
If the brake pedal is depressed sufficiently
the warning lamp and warning sound will be
quickly then full brake function is implemented, used by the cruise control even if the colli-
Activating/deactivating warning signals
even with light pedal force. sion warning system is switched off.
The warning sound and warning lamp are acti-
04
Auto Brake vated automatically when the engine is started The collision warning system warns the
If the driver has not yet started an evasive if the system is switched on. driver in the event of a risk of a collision, but
the function cannot shorten driver reaction
manoeuvre in this situation and the risk of a The warning sound can be activated/deacti- time.
collision is imminent then the Auto Brake func- vated separately using the options for On or
tion comes into effect, without the driver need- In order for the collision warning system to
Off under Car settings Collision warning be effective, always drive with the Distance
ing to touch the brake pedal. Braking then
settings Warning sound. Alert set at time interval 4 – 5. see
takes place with limited brake force in order to page 162.
reduce collision speed. The driver has to brake Set warning distance
in order to achieve full brake force.
The warning distance regulates the distance at
which the visual and acoustic warnings are NOTE
Operation deployed. Select one of the options from Even if the warning distance has been set to
Settings are made from the centre console dis- Long, Normal or Short under Car settings Long then in certain situations warnings
play via a menu system. For information on Collision warning settings Warning could be perceived as being late. E.g. in the
event of large differences in speed or if vehi-
how the menu system is used, see page 120. distance. cles in front brake heavily.
The warning distance determines the system's
NOTE sensitivity. Warning distance Long provides an Checking settings
The Auto Brake function is always switched earlier warning. First test with Long and if this The settings required can be controlled on the
on and cannot be switched off. setting produces too many warnings, which centre console display. Access via the menu
could be perceived as irritating in certain sit-

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 171


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake*

for Car settings Collision warning WARNING Driver Alert Control, see page 175 and Lane
settings, see page 120. Departure Warning, see page 178.
Warnings and braking action could be
implemented late or not at all if the traffic
Limitations situation or external influences mean that NOTE
the radar or camera sensor cannot detect a Keep the windscreen surface in front of the
The visual warning signal may be difficult to
vehicle in front correctly. camera sensor clean from ice, snow, mist
notice in the event of strong sunlight, reflec-
The sensor system has a limited range for and dirt.
tions, when sunglasses are being worn or if the
driver is not looking straight ahead. The warn- stationary or slow vehicles so the system Do not attach or fit anything to the wind-
provides less effective warnings or no warn- screen in front of the camera sensor, as this
ing sound should therefore always be acti-
ings at all at a higher vehicle speed (above could reduce or prevent the function of one
vated. 70 km/h) for such vehicles.
04 or more camera-dependent systems.
Warnings for stationary or slow vehicles
NOTE could be disengaged due to darkness. The camera sensors have limitations similar to
The visual warning signal can be temporarily the human eye, i.e. they "see" worse in dark-
disengaged in the event of high passenger The collision warning system uses the same ness, heavy snowfall or rain and in thick fog for
compartment temperature caused by
strong sunlight for example. If this occurs radar sensors as adaptive cruise control. For example. Under such conditions the functions
then the warning sound is activated even if more information on the radar sensor and its of camera-dependent systems could be sig-
it is deactivated in the menu system. limitations, see page 159. nificantly reduced or temporarily disengaged.
• Warnings may not appear if the dis- An absent or late warning could mean that Strong oncoming light, reflections in the car-
tance to the vehicle in front is small or if there is no brake support or it comes late. riageway, snow or ice on the road surface, dirty
steering wheel and pedal movements road surfaces or unclear lane markings could
If warnings are perceived as being too frequent
are large, e.g. a very active driving style. also significantly reduce a camera sensor func-
or disturbing then the warning distance can be
tion. Functions such as scanning the carriage-
reduced. This would lead to the system warn-
way and detecting other vehicles for example.
ing at a later stage, which reduces the total
number of warnings. During very high temperatures the camera is
temporarily switched off for about 15 minutes
Camera sensor limitations after the engine is started in order to protect
The car's camera sensor is used by the three camera functionality.
functions - Collision Warning with Auto Brake,

172 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake*

Fault tracing and action Cause Action Cause Action


If the display shows the message Windscreen
Sensors blocked then this means that the The windscreen sur- Clean the wind- The windscreen sur- Wait. It may take
camera sensor is blocked and cannot detect face in front of the screen surface in face in front of the several minutes for
vehicles or road markings in front of the car. camera is dirty or front of the camera camera has been the camera to meas-
covered with ice or from dirt, ice and cleaned but the ure the visibility.
In turn this means that the Collision Warning
snow. snow. message remains.
with Auto Brake, Lane Departure Warning and
Driver Alert Control functions are not operating Thick fog, heavy rain No action. At times Dirt has appeared Visit a workshop to
with full functionality. or snow means that the camera does not between the inside have the windscreen
The table presents possible causes for a mes- the camera does not work during heavy of the windscreen inside the camera
work sufficiently rain or snowfall. and the camera. cover cleaned - an 04
sage being shown along with the appropriate
action. well. authorised Volvo
workshop is recom-
mended.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Collis'n warning OFF Collision warning system switched off.
Shown when the engine is started.
The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the READ button.

Collision warn. Unavailable The collision warning system cannot be activated.


Shown when the driver attempts to activate the function.
The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the READ button.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 173


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake*

Symbol Message Specification


Auto braking was acti- Auto Brake has been active.
vated

Windscreen Sensors The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.


blocked Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.

04 Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 172.

Radar blocked. See man- Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily disengaged.
ual The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles, e.g. in the event that heavy rain or slush
has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor, see page 159.

Collision warn. Service Collision Warning with Auto Brake is fully or partially disengaged.
required Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

174 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

Introduction General information on Driver Alert The objective for DAC is to detect slowly dete-
The Driver Alert System is intended to assist Control - DAC riorating driving ability and it is primarily
drivers whose driving ability is deteriorating or intended for major roads. The function is not
who are inadvertently leaving the lane they are intended for city traffic.
driving on. In some cases driving ability is not affected
The Driver Alert System consists of two differ- despite driver fatigue. In which case there may
ent functions, which can either be switched on not be any warning issued for the driver. For
at the same time or individually: this reason it is always important to stop and
take a break in the event of any signs of driver
• Driver Alert Control (DAC) fatigue, irrespective of whether or not DAC
• Lane Departure Warning (LDW), see issues a warning. 04
page 178.

G017332
A switched-on function is set in standby mode NOTE
and is not activated automatically until speed The function must not be used to extend a
exceeds 65 km/h. The function is intended to attract the driver's driving stint. Always plan breaks at regular
The function is deactivated again when speed attention when he/she starts to drive less con- intervals and ensure that you are fully
decreases to below 60 km/h. sistently, e.g. if he/she becomes distracted or rested.
starts to fall asleep.
Both functions use a camera which is depend-
ent on the lane having side markings painted A camera detects the side markings painted on Limitation
on each side. the carriageway and compares the section of In some cases the system may issue a warning
the road with the driver's steering wheel move- despite driving ability not deteriorating, for
ments. The driver is alerted if the vehicle does example:
WARNING
not follow the carriageway evenly. • if the driver tests the LDW function.
The Driver Alert System does not work in all
situations but is instead only intended to be • in strong side winds.
of supplementary assistance. NOTE
• on rutted road surfaces.
The driver always has ultimate responsibility The camera sensor has certain limitations,
that the car is driven safely. see page 172.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 175


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

Operation Thumbwheel. Turn the rotary control until If the vehicle is driven inconsistently then the
Some settings are made from the centre con- the display shows Driver driver is alerted by an acoustic signal as well as
sole display and its menu system. For informa- Alert. The second row displays the Off, U the text message Driver Alert Time for a
tion on how the menu system is used, see navailable or Level mark options. break. The warning is repeated after a time if
page 120. READ button. Confirms or clears a warning driving ability does not improve.
The current status can be checked on the trip in the memory.
computer display with the left-hand stalk
WARNING
Activating Driver Alert Control
switch. An alarm should be taken most seriously as
Using the centre console display with its menu a sleepy driver is not usually aware of his/
system, locate Car settings Driver Alert. her condition.
04 Select the On option. In the event of an alarm or signs of driver
The function is activated when speed fatigue; stop the car in a safe manner as
exceeds 65 km/h and it remains soon as possible and rest.
active as long as the speed exceeds Studies have shown that it is equally as dan-
60 km/h. The display shows a level gerous to drive when tired as it is under the
mark with 1-5 bars, where a low number of bars influence of alcohol.
indicates inconsistent driving ability. A high
number of bars indicates stable driving.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Driver Alert OFF Function not switched on.

Driver Alert Unavailable Speed is lower than 60 km/h, the carriageway does not have clear side markings or the camera sensor
is temporarily disengaged. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 172.

176 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

Symbol Message Specification


Driver Alert The function analyses the driver's driving style.
The number of bars can vary in the range 1-5, where a low number of bars indicates inconsistent
driving ability. A high number of bars indicates stable driving.

Driver Alert Time for a The vehicle has been driven inconsistently; the driver is alerted by an acoustic warning signal + text.
break

Windscreen Sensors The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.


04
blocked Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 172.

Driver Alert Sys Service The system is disengaged.


required Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 177


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

General information on Lane Departure Operation and function If the camera can no longer detect the carria-
Warning - LDW geway's side markings or if speed decreases
to below 60 km/h then the function resumes
standby mode and the display shows Lane
Depart Warn Unavailable.
If the vehicle crosses the left or right-hand side
marking of the carriageway without due cause
then the driver is alerted by an acoustic signal.
No warning is given in the following situations:

04 • Direction indicators activated


• The driver has his/her foot on the brake
pedal1
The function is switched on or off by means of • In the event of the accelerator pedal being
The function is intended to reduce the risk for a switch on the centre console. An indicator depressed rapidly1
single-vehicle accidents – accidents where, in lamp in the button illuminates when the func- • In the event of rapid steering wheel move-
certain situations, the vehicle leaves the car- tion is switched on. ments1
riageway and is in danger of driving either into
The trip computer display shows Lane Depart • In the event of a sudden turn so that the car
a ditch or into oncoming traffic.
Warn Unavailable when the function is in rolls.
LDW consists of a camera that detects the side standby mode. The camera sensor also has certain limitations.
markings painted on the carriageway. The For more information, see page 172.
The LDW function is activated automatically
driver is alerted by an acoustic signal if the
from standby mode after the camera has scan-
vehicle crosses a side marking.
ned in the carriageway's side markings and NOTE
speed exceeds 65 km/h. The trip computer
The driver is only warned once each time the
display then shows Lane Depart Warn wheels cross a line. So there is no acoustic
Available. alarm when there is a line between the car's
wheels.

1 A warning is still given when Increased sensitivity is selected, see page 180.

178 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Lane departure warning The function is switched on/off.
On/Off Shown at switch-on/off.
The text disappears after 5 seconds.

Lane Depart Warn Availa- The function scans the carriageway's side markings.
ble

Lane Depart Warn Unavail- Speed is lower than 60 km/h, the carriageway does not have clear side markings or the camera sensor 04
able is temporarily disengaged. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 172.

Windscreen Sensors The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.


blocked Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 172.

Driver Alert Sys Service The system is disengaged.


required Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 179


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

Personal preferences
See the centre console display with its menu
system and there search for Car settings
Lane departure warning, see page 120.
Select the option required:
On at start up: This option sets the function in
standby mode each time the car is started.
Otherwise the same value as when the engine
was switched off is obtained.

04 Increased sensitivity: This option increases


sensitivity, an alarm is triggered earlier and
fewer limitations apply.

180 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

General The system is automatically activated when the


car is started and the switch's On/Off lamp is 1
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the illuminated. If parking assistance is switched
audio system display indicate the distance to off with the button, the lamp goes out. Active
the detected obstacle. The centre console display shows an overview 2
Parking assistance is available in two variants: of the relationship between the car and
detected obstacle.
• Rear only Active
Marked fields show which of the four sensors
• Both front and rear.
detected an obstacle. The more marked fields 3
in the same bar, the shorter the distance
WARNING between the car and detected obstacle. Active 04
Parking assistance does not relinquish the The frequency of the signal increases the Display screens in different situations.
driver's own responsibility during parking.
The sensors have blind spots where obsta- shorter the distance to an obstacle, in front of Display in car with only rear sensors.
cles cannot be detected. Be aware of chil- or behind the car. Other sound from the audio Obstacle detected by both right-hand sen-
dren and animals near the car. system is muted automatically. sors.
Display in car with both front and rear sen-
sors. The front right-hand sensor is 30 cm
Function or closer to a detected obstacle.
Display in car with both front and rear sen-
sors. Reverse gear engaged, no front or
rear obstacle detected.
When the distance is within 30 cm the tone is
constant and the marked sensors' bar is fully
filled in, see figure (2). If the detected obstacle
is within the distance for the constant tone both
behind and in front of the car, then the tone
sounds alternately from the loudspeakers.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 181


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

Rear parking assistance Front parking assistance IMPORTANT


When fitting auxiliary lamps: Remember that
they must not obscure the sensors – the
auxiliary lamps could then be detected as
obstacles.

Fault indicator
If the information symbol illuminates
with constant glow and the informa-
04 tion display shows Park assist syst Service
required then parking assistance is disen-
gaged.
The distance covered to the rear of the car is The distance covered to the front of the car is
about 1.5 metres. The acoustic signal for about 0.8 metres. The acoustic signal for IMPORTANT
obstacles behind comes from the rear loud- obstacles in front comes from the front loud- In certain conditions the parking assistance
speakers. speaker. system may produce incorrect warning sig-
Rear parking assistance is activated when Front parking assistance is active at speeds up nals that are caused by external audio
sources that emit the same ultrasonic fre-
reverse gear is engaged. to 15 km/h, and also during reversing. The sys-
quencies that the system works with.
tem is deactivated at a higher speed. However,
The system must be deactivated when revers- Examples of such sources include horns,
the lamp in the button remains illuminated in
ing with a trailer, or bike carrier on the towbar wet tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and
order to indicate that the system is activated
or similar -otherwise they would trigger the exhaust noises from motorcycles etc.
for the next time the driver shall park. When the
sensors.
speed is below 10 km/h the system is reacti-
vated.
NOTE
Rear parking assistance is deactivated NOTE
automatically when towing a trailer if Volvo
genuine trailer wiring is used. Front parking assistance is deactivated
when the parking brake is applied.

182 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

Cleaning the sensors NOTE


Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors may
cause incorrect warning signals.

04

G031402
Sensor location, front.

Sensor location, rear.


The sensors must be cleaned regularly to
ensure that they work properly. Clean them
with water and car shampoo.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 183


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

General information on PAC Function NOTE


The PAC (Park Assist Camera) displays what is
Objects on the display screen may be closer
behind the car during reversing by means of a to the car than they appear to be on the
display screen. screen.
Using references lines in the display screen,
the system also indicates where the car will end Light conditions
up based on steering wheel movement. This The camera automatically detects light condi-
makes it easier to parallel park, reverse into tions and continually adjusts sensitivity.
tight spaces or connect a trailer. Because of this, the image may vary slightly in
PAC can also be installed on cars equipped brightness and quality. In poor light conditions
04 or darkness, the camera compensates by
with Volvo genuine GPS navigator RTI* - Road
and Traffic Information System. increasing light sensitivity, which could reduce
image quality.
The driver has the facility to see what is behind
WARNING If the display screen seems too dark, bright-
the car and if something appears from the
ness can be increased with the thumbwheel for
• The parking camera serves as an aid. It sides.
instrument lighting, see page 80.
does not relieve the driver of responsi-
bility when reversing. The parking camera is mounted at the opening
handle of the tailgate. NOTE
• The camera has blind spots, where
obstacles cannot be detected. The camera's strong wide-angle lens shows a In poor light conditions, it is extremely
wide area behind the car as well as its bumper important that the camera lens is free of dirt,
• Be aware of people and animals in the
and towbar. snow and ice.
vicinity of the car.
The system's electronic image processing cor-
rects the "fisheye" effect of the camera image
to display a natural image. As a result, objects
on the screen may appear to be tilted. This is
perfectly normal.

184 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

Operation Guide lines IMPORTANT


Activation Bear in mind that the screen only shows the
The parking camera is activated when reverse area behind the car - pay attention to the
gear is engaged, if the function is preselected sides and front of the car when manoeuvring
during reversing.
in the menu system, see page 120.
If RTI is active, the PAC system automatically
Boundary lines
takes over and the camera image appears on
the display screen instead of navigation sys-
tem information.
04
Deactivation
The camera works with a delay. This means
that the image behind the car may be shown
even if reverse gear has been disengaged in The lines on the screen are projected as if they
order to drive the car forward a little. were at ground level behind the car and are
directly related to steering wheel movement,
After reversing is complete, the camera image which shows the driver the path the car will
remains for approx. 5 seconds or until speed take, even when turning.
exceeds 10 km/h.
The system then resumes whatever mode was
NOTE PAC system lines.
active prior to reverse gear engagement - e.g. • When reversing with a trailer, the lines Boundary line, 30 cm zone backwards
the RTI system is reactivated. on the screen show the path of the car from the car
- not the trailer.
Boundary line, free reversing zone
• The screen shows no lines when a trailer
is connected to the car's electrical sys- "Wheel tracks"
tem.
The unbroken line (1) frames in a zone that is
within about 30 cm from the bumper.
The dashed line (2) frames in an obstacle-free
zone up to about 1.5 m back from the bumper.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 185


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

It is also the limit of the car's most protruding • YELLOW: 1.5> m large sector that is hidden from view. Obsta-
parts, such as door mirrors and corners - also • ORANGE: 0.3-1.5 m cles could thereby go undetected until they are
during turning. very close to the car.
• RED: <0.3 m.
The wide "wheel tracks" (3) between the side To bear in mind
lines indicate where the wheels will roll and can Settings
To set system activation, press MENU and go
• Keep the camera lens free from dirt, ice
extend about 3.2 m back from the bumper if no and snow.
obstacle is in the way. to Main menu Car settings . Select from
the following options:
• Clean the camera lens regularly with luke-
Cars equipped with Park Assist warm water and car shampoo - take care
Parking camera settings not to scratch the lens.
• Select Park Assist lines to show side lines
04 when reversing.
• Select Distance Bars to show distance
lines when reversing1.
System activation
• Select Automatic for PAC to be active
during reversing.
• Select Off for PAC to be permanently off.

Limitations
If the car is also equipped with Park Assist* rear
(see page 181) the distance indication will be NOTE
more precise and the coloured areas show A bike carrier or other accessory mounted
which of the four sensors is/are registering an on the rear of the car could obscure the
obstacle. camera's view.
The colour changes with decreasing distance
to the obstacle - from yellow to orange to red. Even if it only looks like a relatively small part
of the image is obscured, it could be a relatively

1 Only if Park Assist is installed.

186 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

General information on BLIS WARNING Blind spots


The system is a supplement to, not a
replacement for, a safe driving style and use
of the rearview mirrors. It can never replace
the driver's attention and responsibility. The
responsibility for changing lanes safely
always rests with the driver.

The system is designed to work most effec-


tively when driving in dense traffic on multi-lane
highways. 04

G031404

G017834
When a camera has detected a vehicle
inside the blind spot zone the indicator lamp A = approx. 9.5 m and B = approx. 3 m
BLIS camera
illuminates with a constant glow.
Indicator lamp
Activating/deactivating
BLIS symbol NOTE
The lamp illuminates on the side of the car
BLIS is an information system based on cam- where the system has detected the vehicle.
era technology that under certain conditions If the car is overtaken on both sides at the
can help the driver to notice vehicles moving in same time then both lamps illuminate.
the same direction as the host vehicle in the so-
called "blind spot".
BLIS advises the driver with a message if a fault
IMPORTANT arises in the system. If for example the sys-
tem's cameras are obscured then the BLIS
Repair of the BLIS system components indicator lamp flashes and a message is shown
must only be performed by a workshop - an
on the information display. In such cases,
authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended. check and clean the lenses.
If necessary, the system can be switched off Button for activating/deactivating.
temporarily by pressing the BLIS button once,
see page 187.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 187


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

BLIS is activated when the engine is started. WARNING WARNING


The indicator lamps in the door panels flash
three times when BLIS is activated. BLIS does not work in sharp bends. The system does not react to bicycles or
mopeds.
The system can be deactivated/activated BLIS does not work when the car is revers-
ing. The BLIS cameras can be disrupted by
when the engine is started by pressing the intensive light or when driving in the dark
BLIS button. A wide trailer coupled to the car can conceal
when there are no light sources (e.g. street
other vehicles in adjacent lanes. It can pre-
When BLIS is deactivated the light in the button lighting or other vehicles). The system may
vent the vehicle in the screened area from
then interpret the lack of light as if the cam-
goes out and a text message is shown on the being detected by BLIS.
eras have been blocked.
dashboard display.
In both cases a message is shown in the
04 When BLIS is activated the light in the button Daylight and darkness information display.
illuminates, a new text message is shown on In daylight the system reacts to the shape of
When driving in such conditions system
the display and the indicator lamps in the door the surrounding vehicles. The system is
performance may be temporarily deterio-
panels flash three times. Press the READ but- designed to detect motor vehicles such as rate and a text message is shown, see
ton to clear the text message. For more infor- cars, trucks, buses and motorcycles. page 188. If the message disappears auto-
mation on messages, see page 123. matically then BLIS has returned to normal
In darkness the system reacts to the head-
functionality.
lamps of surrounding vehicles. If the head-
When BLIS operates lamps of surrounding vehicles are not switched The BLIS cameras have limitations similar to
on then the system does not detect the vehi- the human eye, i.e. they "see" worse in
The system operates when the car is driven at
cles. This means for example that the system heavy snowfall or thick fog for example.
a speed above 10 km/h.
does not react to a trailer without headlamps
Overtaking which is towed behind a car or truck.
The system is designed to react if:
Cleaning
In order to work most effectively the BLIS cam-
• you overtake another vehicle at a speed of era lenses must be clean. The lenses can be
up to 10 km/h faster than the other vehicle cleaned with a soft cloth or damp sponge.
• you are overtaken by a vehicle travelling up Clean the lenses carefully so that they are not
to 70 km/h faster than you are travelling. scratched.

188 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

IMPORTANT Message Specification Here are several examples of situations where


the BLIS indicator lamp may illuminate even if
The lenses are electrically heated to melt ice Blind spot syst. The BLIS camera is there is no other vehicle within the blind spot.
or snow. If necessary, brush snow away
from the lenses. Reduced function disrupted by fog or
strong sunlight shin-
ing directly into the
Messages on the display camera.
The camera resets
Message Specification
itself when the envi-
Blind-spot info BLIS system on ronment has
system ON returned to normal. 04

Blind spot syst. BLIS not function- Blind-spot info BLIS system off Reflection from shiny wet road surface.
Service required ing. system OFF
Contact a workshop
- an authorised Limitations
Volvo workshop is
In some situations the BLIS indicator lamp may
recommended.
illuminate despite there being no other vehicle
Blind spot syst. The BLIS camera is within the blind spot.
Camera blocked blocked by dirt,
snow or ice. Clean NOTE
the lenses. If the BLIS indicator lamp illuminates on iso- Own shadow on large light smooth surface, e.g.
lated occasions despite there being no noise barrier or concrete road surface.
other vehicle within the blind spot then this
does not mean that a fault has arisen in the
system.
In the event of a fault in the BLIS system the
display shows the text Blind spot syst.
Service required.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 189


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

Low stationary sunlight shining into the camera.


04

190 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

Storage spaces

04

G031433
``

191
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

Storage compartment in door panel Tunnel console out the lighter and light a cigarette on the
heated coils.
Storage pocket* on front edge of front seat
cushions
Glovebox
Ticket clip
Glovebox
Storage compartment, cup holder
Jacket holder

04 Cup holder* in armrest, rear seat


Storage pocket
Storage compartment (e.g. for CDs) and
Jacket holder
USB*/AUX input under the armrest.
The jacket holder is only designed for light
clothing. Includes cup holder for driver and passen-
ger. (If ashtray and cigarette lighter are The owner's manual and maps can be kept
specified then there is a cigarette lighter in here for example. There are also holders for
the 12 V socket for the front seat, see pens on the inside of the lid. The glovebox can
page 193, and a detachable ashtray in the be locked with the key blade, see page 47.
cup holder.)
Avoid storing coins, keys or similar metal
Floor mats*
objects in the cup holder as such objects could
accidentally trigger the alarm*, see page 59. Volvo supplies specially manufactured floor
mats.
Cigarette lighter and ashtray*
The ashtray in the tunnel console is detached
by lifting the tray straight up.
Activate the lighter by pushing in the button.
The button pops out when the lighter is hot. Pull

192 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

WARNING 12 V socket the socket to supply current, the remote con-


trol key must be in at least key position I, see
The floor mat at the driver's seat must be page 73.
firmly fitted and secured in the attachment
clips to prevent it from being trapped
around and under the pedals. WARNING
Always leave the plug in the socket when
the socket is not in use.
Vanity mirror
Electrical socket in cargo area*
04

G031435
12 V socket, front seat.

G021438

Vanity mirror with lighting.


The lamp for the vanity mirror, on the driver's
side* and passenger side respectively, is Fold down the cover to access the electrical
switched on automatically when the cover is socket. It works even when the remote control

G021440
raised. key is not in the ignition switch.

12 V socket in tunnel console, rear seat. NOTE


The electrical socket can be used for 12 V Remember not to use the electrical socket
accessories, such as mobile phone chargers with the engine switched off because of the
and coolers. The maximum current is 10 A. For risk of discharging the car's battery.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 193


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Bluetooth handsfree*

General NOTE EXIT - End/refuse phone calls, clear


entered characters, interrupt current func-
Only a selection of mobile phones are fully tion. Same functionality available in steer-
compatible with the handsfree function.
ing wheel keypad.
Volvo recommends that you seek assis-
tance from an authorised Volvo dealer or ENTER – Accept calls. A press of the but-
www.volvocars.com for information on ton reveals latest dialled numbers. Same
compatible phones. functionality available in steering wheel
keypad.

Phone functions, controls overview


Remember
04 The menus are controlled from the centre con-
sole and the steering wheel keypad. For gen-
System overview.
eral information on menus, see page 120.
Mobile phone Activating/deactivating
A short press on PHONE activates the hands-
Microphone
free function. The text PHONE at the top of the
Steering wheel keypad display shows that it is in phone mode. The
symbol shows that the handsfree func-
Centre console
tion is active.
BluetoothTM One long press on PHONE deactivates the
A mobile phone equipped with BluetoothTM Centre console control panel. handsfree function and disconnects a con-
can be connected wirelessly to the audio sys- VOLUME – Same functionality available in nected phone.
tem. The audio system then works handsfree, steering wheel keypad.
Connect mobile phone
with the option to control a range of the mobile Number and letter buttons A mobile phone is connected in different ways
phone's functions remotely. The mobile phone
PHONE - On/off and standby mode depending on whether or not it has been con-
can be operated by its own keys irrespective of
nected previously. To connect a mobile phone
whether or not it is connected.
Navigation button for the first time, follow the instructions below:

194 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Bluetooth handsfree*

Alternative 1 - via the car's menu system Alternative 2 - via the phone's menu system To call
1. Make the mobile phone detectable/visible 1. Activate the handsfree function with 1. Make sure that the text PHONE is shown
via BluetoothTM, see mobile phone manual PHONE. If there is a phone connected, at the top of the display and that the
or www.volvocars.com. disconnect the connected phone. symbol is visible.
2. Activate the handsfree function with 2. Search with the phone's BluetoothTM, see 2. Dial the number or use the phone book,
PHONE. the mobile phone manual. see page 197.
> Menu option Add phone appears on 3. Select My Car in the list of units detected 3. Press ENTER.
the display. If one or more mobile in your mobile phone. The call is interrupted with EXIT.
phones have already been registered
then these are also shown. 4. Enter the PIN code '1234' into the mobile
Disconnecting the mobile phone 04
phone when prompted for the PIN code.
3. Select Add phone. Automatic disconnection takes place if the
5. Select to connect to My Car from the mobile phone moves out of the audio system's
> The audio system searches for mobile
mobile phone. range. For more information on connection,
phones in the vicinity. The search takes
The mobile phone is registered and connected see page 197.
approximately 30 seconds. The mobile
phones detected are specified with their automatically to the audio system while the text Manual disconnection takes place by deacti-
respective BluetoothTM name in the dis- Synchronising is shown in the display. For vating the handsfree function with one long
play. The handsfree function's more information on how mobile phones are press on PHONE. The handsfree function is
BluetoothTM name is shown in the registered, see page 197. also deactivated when the engine is switched
mobile phone such as My Car. When the connection is established the symbol off or when a door is opened1.
4. Choose one of the mobile phones in the is shown and the mobile phone When the mobile phone has been discon-
audio system display. BluetoothTM name is shown in the display. Now nected an ongoing call can be continued with
the mobile phone can be controlled from the the mobile phone's built-in microphone and
5. Enter the number series shown in the audio
audio system. speaker.
system display via the mobile phone key-
pad.

1 Only Keyless Drive.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 195


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Bluetooth handsfree*

NOTE NOTE The audio source can be automatically muted


for incoming calls under Phone settings
Some mobile phones require that the With certain mobile phones the connection
changeover from handsfree is confirmed is terminated when the privacy function is Sounds and volume Mute radio.
from the phone's keypad. used. This is normal. The handsfree function
asks if you want to reconnect. Ring volume
Go to Phone settings Sounds and volume
Making and receiving calls • Phone book – searching in the phone Ring volume and adjust with / on the
book. navigation button.
Incoming call
Calls are accepted with ENTER even if the Ring signals
audio system is in CD or FM mode for example. NOTE
04 The handsfree function has integrated ring sig-
Refuse or end with EXIT. A new call cannot be started during an nals that can be selected under Phone
ongoing call. settings Sounds and volume Ring
Automatic answer
The automatic answer function means that signals Ring signal 1, 2, 3 etc.
calls are accepted automatically. Audio settings
± Activate/deactivate under Phone settings NOTE
Phone call volume
Call options Automatic answer. The call volume can be regulated when the The connected mobile phone's ring signal is
not deactivated when one of the handsfree
handsfree function is in phone mode. Use the system's integrated signals is used.
In call menu
steering wheel keypad or VOLUME.
Press MENU or ENTER during an ongoing call
to access the following functions: Audio system volume In order to select the connected phone's ring
• Mute microphone - audio system micro- Providing there is no ongoing call taking place, signal2, go to Phone settings Sounds and
phone is muted. the audio system volume is controlled as usual volume Ring signals Use mobile
with VOLUME. In order to control audio system phone signal.
• Transfer call to mobile - the call is trans- volume during an ongoing call you have to
ferred to the mobile phone.
switch to one of the audio sources.

2 Not supported by all mobile phones.

196 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Bluetooth handsfree*

More on registering and connecting Phone book The phone book can also be reached with /
A maximum of five mobile phones can be reg- All use of the phone book presupposes that the on the navigation button or with / on
istered. Registration is performed once per text PHONE is shown at the top of the display the steering wheel keypad. The search can also
phone. After registration the phone no longer and that the symbol is visible. be performed from the phone book's Search
needs to be visible/detectable. A maximum of menu under Phone book Search:
one mobile phone can be connected at a time. The audio system stores a copy of the phone
Phones can be deregistered under Bluetooth book from each registered mobile phone. The 1. Enter the first few letters of the contact and
phone book is copied automatically to the press ENTER, or simply press ENTER.
Remove phone.
audio system during each connection.
2. Scroll to a contact and press ENTER to
Automatic connection ± Deactivate the function under Phone call.
When the handsfree function is active and the settings Synchronise phone book. 04
last mobile phone connected is in range it is Searching for contacts is only performed in Voice recognition
connected automatically. When the audio sys- the connected mobile phone's phone The mobile phone's voice recognition function
tem searches for the last phone connected its book. for dialling can be used by holding in ENTER.
name is shown in the display. To change over
to manual connection of another phone, press Voice mail number
NOTE Voice mail number can be changed under
EXIT.
If the mobile phone does not support copy- Phone settings Call options Voice mail
Manual connection ing of the phone book then List is empty is number. If there is no number stored then this
If you want to connect a mobile phone other shown when copying is finished. menu can be reached with one long press on
than the last connected or change the con- 1. Press 1 for a long time to use the stored
nected mobile phone, proceed as follows: If the phone book contains a ringing caller's number.
1. Set the audio system in phone mode. contact information then this is shown in the
display. Call lists
2. Press PHONE and select one of the The call lists are copied to the handsfree func-
phones in the list. Searching for contacts tion at each new connection and are then
The connection can also be made via the menu The easiest way to search in the phone book is updated during the connection. Press ENTER
system under Bluetooth Connect phone with long presses on the keys 2–9. This starts to show the last dialled. Other call lists are
a search in the phone book based on the key's available under Call register.
or Change phone.
first letter.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 197


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Bluetooth handsfree*

NOTE Key Function


Certain mobile phones show a list of the last PQRS7ß
dialled calls in reverse order.

TUV8ÜÙ
Inputting text
Input text using the keypad in the centre con-
sole. Press once for the key's first character, WXYZ9
twice for the second etc. Continue pressing for
more characters, see the following table. Pressed briefly if two characters
A short press on EXIT deletes an input char- shall be entered after each other
04
acter. One long press on EXIT clears all input with the same key.
characters. / on the navigation button +0@*#&$£/%
scrolls between the characters.

Key Function Shift between upper and lower


case letter
Space . 1 - ? ! , : " ' ( )

ABC2ÄÅÀÆÇ

DEF3ÈÉ

GHI4Ì

JKL5

MNO6ÑÖÒØ

198 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Built-in phone*

General Remember Switch off the phone with one long press on
PHONE.
SIM card
The phone can only be used with a valid SIM
card Subscriber Identity Module. For installa- Making and receiving calls
tion, see page 202. Emergency calls to emer- Making calls
gency numbers can be made without a SIM 1. Switch on the phone.
card.
2. If PHONE is not shown in the display,
NOTE briefly press PHONE.

The built-in phone cannot read 3G type SIM 3. Dial the number or use the phone book,
04
cards. Combined 3G/GSM cards work. see page 200.
Contact the network operator if the SIM 4. Press ENTER for handsfree calls or pick up
System overview. card needs to be changed.
the privacy handset. Release the handset
Microphone by pulling it down.
Menus and controls
SIM card reader The menus are navigated using the control Ending a call
panel and the steering wheel keypad. End a call by pressing EXIT or by hanging up
Keypad, see page 137.
For general information on menus, see the privacy handset.
Control panel page 120. For information on the phone's con- Incoming call
Privacy handset trols, see page 194.
Press ENTER for handsfree calls or pick up the
On/Off privacy handset. If the privacy handset is off
Safety Switch on the phone with a short press on the hook when the phone rings then calls must
Engage a workshop to perform the service via PHONE. Enter the PIN code if necessary. The be received using ENTER.
the phone. Volvo recommends that you seek
symbol shows that the phone is switched End calls by pressing EXIT or by hanging up
assistance from an authorised Volvo work-
on. When this symbol is shown calls can be the privacy handset. Refuse calls using EXIT.
shop. The built-in phone must be switched off
received even if the CD menu for example is
during refuelling or in the vicinity of blasting Automatic answer
shown in the display. Briefly press PHONE to
work. IDIS limits the menu system depending See page 196.
use the phone menus and to dial out. The text
on the speed of the car, see page 201.
PHONE shows that the phone menu is active.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 199


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Built-in phone*

Call waiting another is on hold. The Join menu option starts Signals and volume
The function enables a new call to be answered the conference call. Change the ring signal under Phone settings
during an ongoing call. The new call is All ongoing calls are disconnected if the con- Sounds and volume Ring signals.
answered as usual and the previous call is put ference call is terminated.
on hold. Activate/deactivate the message beep under
Switching between the privacy handset Phone settings Sounds and volume
± Activate/deactivate under Phone settings
and handsfree Message beep.
Call options Call waiting.
Switch from handsfree to the privacy handset Control the ring volume under Phone settings
Automatic diversions by picking up the privacy handset or selecting Sounds and volume Ring volume.
Incoming calls can be diverted automatically in the menu. Adjust using / on the navigation button.
04 depending on the type of call and situation. Switch from the privacy handset to handsfree
± Activate/deactivate under Call options using the Handsfree menu option.
Phone book
Diversions. Contact information can be stored on the SIM
Mute mode
Mute mode involves deactivating the micro- card or in the phone.
During a call phone, see page 199.
Storing contacts in the phone book
Press MENU or ENTER during a call to access ± Activate/deactivate the microphone using 1. Press MENU and scroll to Phone book
the In-call menu. the Microphone On/Off menu option. New contact.
To call 2. Enter a name and press ENTER. For infor-
1. Put the call on hold under Hold. Audio settings mation on text input, see below.
2. Dial the number of the third party or use the Phone call volume 3. Enter a number and press ENTER.
Phone book menu option. The phone uses the front door speakers. Call
4. Scroll to SIM card or Phone memory and
Switch between calls using the Swap menu volume can be controlled when the text
press ENTER.
option. PHONE is shown at the top of the display.
± Use the steering wheel keypad or Inputting text
Conference call VOLUME. See page 198.
A conference call consists of several parties. It
can be initiated when a call is underway and Audio system volume Searching for contacts
See page 138. See page 197.

200 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Built-in phone*

Erasing contacts 3. The message text is shown in the display. Call duration
Erase a contact in the phone book by selecting Additional selections can be made by Call duration is stored under Call register
it and pressing ENTER. Then scroll to Erase pressing ENTER. Call duration.
and press ENTER.
Writing and sending messages ± Reset the values under Call register
Erase all contacts under Phone book Erase 1. Scroll to Messages Write new and Call duration Reset timers.
SIM or Erase phone. press ENTER.
Show/hide number for third party
Copying entries between the SIM card 2. Enter text and press ENTER. For informa-
The phone number can be temporarily hidden
and the phone book tion on text input, see page 198.
under Call options Send my number.
Go to Phone book Copy all SIM to 3. Scroll to Send and press ENTER.
phone or Phone to SIM and press ENTER. IMEI number 04
4. Enter a phone number and press ENTER.
In order to block a phone the network provider
Voice mail number must be advised of the phone's IMEI number.
Message settings
See page 197.
Message settings are not normally changed. ± Dial *#06# to show the number in the dis-
The network provider has further information play. Write it down and keep it in a safe
Other functions and settings on these settings. There are three options place.
under Messages Message settings:
IDIS Network selection
IDIS (Intelligent Driver Information System) • SMSC number - Specifies the message The network can be selected either automati-
can, in active driving situations, delay or refuse centre which will transfer the messages.
cally or manually under Phone settings
ring signals from incoming calls. This way less • Validity time - Specifies how long the Network selection.
attention is distracted from driving. message will be stored in the message
± IDIS is deactivated under Phone settings centre. SIM code and security
IDIS. • Message type. The PIN code can protect the SIM card from
unauthorised use.
Reading messages Call lists
The code can be changed under Phone
1. Scroll to Messages Read and press Lists of received, dialled and missed calls are
stored in Call register. Dialled calls are also settings Edit PIN code.
ENTER.
shown by pressing ENTER. The phone num- Change the security level under Phone
2. Scroll to a message and press ENTER. bers in the lists can be saved in the phone settings SIM security.
book.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 201


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Built-in phone*

Select maximum security with the On option.


The code will then need to be entered each
time the phone is switched on.
Select the next highest security level with the
Automatic option. The phone then stores the
code and automatically specifies it when the
phone is switched on. When the SIM card is
used with another phone the code must be
entered manually.

G021451
Select minimum security with the Off option.
04 The SIM card can then be used without the
code at all.
Make sure that the phone is deactivated.
Reset to factory settings Pull out the SIM card holder which is
The phone settings are fully reset under Phone located in the glovebox.
settings Reset phone settings. Place the SIM card with the metal surface
visible and fit the cover on the SIM card
Installing the SIM card holder . Refit the SIM card holder.
G021450

202 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

04

203
Recommendations during driving......................................................... 206
Refuelling.............................................................................................. 208
Fuel....................................................................................................... 209
Loading................................................................................................. 212
Cargo area............................................................................................ 213
Warning triangle*................................................................................... 217
Driving with a trailer.............................................................................. 218
Towing and recovery............................................................................. 224

204 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


DURING YOUR JOURNEY

05
05 During your journey

Recommendations during driving

General been passed, depress the brake pedal lightly cooling system will overheat. Proceed as fol-
and check that full brake function is achieved. lows to avoid overheating the engine:
Economical driving Water and mud for example can make the
Economical driving and reducing environmen- brake linings wet resulting in delayed brake
• Maintain a low speed when driving with a
trailer up long, steep ascents.
tal impact result from driving gently with antic- function.
ipation and adapting your driving style and • Do not turn the engine off immediately you
speed to the current situation (for further Clean the electric contacts of the electric stop after a hard drive.
advice on how you can reduce environmental engine block heater and trailer coupling after
impact, see page 10). driving in water and mud. NOTE
Do not let the car stand with water over the sills
• Do not let the engine idle, but drive at light It is normal for the engine's cooling fan to
loads as soon as it is possible. for any long period of time. This could cause operate for a while after the engine has been
electrical malfunctions. switched off.
• A cold engine consumes more fuel than a
warm one. IMPORTANT
• Do not drive with unnecessary loads in the • Remove any auxiliary lamps from in front
Engine damage can occur if water enters of the grille when driving in extreme high
05
car. the air filter. temperatures.
• Do not use winter tyres when the roads are In depths greater than 25 cm, water could
dry. • Do not exceed engine speeds of
enter the transmission. This reduces the 4500 rpm (3500 rpm for diesel engines) if
• Remove the load carrier when it is not in lubricating ability of the oils and shortens driving with a trailer or caravan in hilly ter-
use. the service life of these systems. rain. The oil temperature could become too
• Use the parking heater* in cold weather so In the event of the engine stalling in water, high.
that the engine reaches its normal operat- do not try restart - tow the car from the water
ing temperature more quickly. to a workshop - an authorised Volvo work- Open tailgate
shop is recommended. Risk of engine Avoid driving with the tailgate open. If it is how-
Driving in water breakdown. ever necessary, only drive for a short distance.
The car can be driven through water at a maxi- Close all windows, set the air distribution to the
mum depth of 25 cm at a maximum speed of Engine and cooling system windscreen and floor and run the fan at the
10 km/h. Extra caution should be exercised Under special conditions, for example when highest speed.
when passing through flowing water. driving in hilly terrain, extreme heat or with
During driving in water, maintain a low speed heavy loads, there is a risk that the engine and
and do not stop the car. When the water has

206 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 During your journey

Recommendations during driving

WARNING Before a long journey • The condition of the battery and charge
• Check that the engine is working normally level must be inspected. Cold weather pla-
Do not drive with the tailgate open. Toxic and that fuel consumption is normal. ces great demands on the battery and its
exhaust fumes could be drawn into the car capacity is reduced by the cold.
through the cargo area. • Make sure that there are no leaks (fuel, oil
or other fluid). • Use washer fluid to avoid ice forming in the
washer fluid reservoir.
Do not overload the battery • Check all bulbs and tyre tread depths.
To achieve optimum roadholding Volvo rec-
The electrical functions in the car load the bat- • Carrying a warning triangle is a legal
ommends using winter tyres on all four wheels
tery to varying degrees. Avoid using the ignition requirement in certain countries.
if there is a risk of snow or ice.
position II when the engine is switched off. Use
ignition position I instead, as less power is con-
Winter driving
sumed. Check the following in particular before the NOTE
cold season:
Also, be aware of different accessories that The use of winter tyres is a legal requirement
load the electrical system. Do not use functions • The engine coolant must contain at least in certain countries. Studded tyres are not
50% glycol. This mixture protects the permitted in certain countries.
which use a lot of power when the engine is
engine down to approximately –35 °C. To 05
switched off. Examples of functions that use a
achieve optimum antifreeze protection, Slippery driving conditions
lot of power: different types of glycol must not be mixed. Practise driving on slippery surfaces under
• ventilation fan • The fuel tank must be kept filled to prevent controlled conditions to learn how the car
• windscreen wiper condensation. reacts.
• audio system (high volume) • Engine oil viscosity is important. Oils with
lower viscosity (thinner oils) facilitate star-
• parking lamps
ting in cold weather and also reduce fuel
If the battery voltage is low, a message appears consumption while the engine is cold. For
on the information display. The energy-saving more information on suitable oils, see
function shuts down certain functions or page 278.
reduces certain functions such as the ventila-
tion fan and audio system. Charge the battery IMPORTANT
by starting the engine.
Low viscosity oil must not be used for hard
driving or in hot weather.

207
05 During your journey

Refuelling

Refuelling Opening/closing the fuel cap Opening the fuel filler flap manually
Opening/closing the fuel filler flap

A certain overpressure may arise in the tank in The fuel filler flap can be opened manually
05 the event of high outside temperatures. Open when electric opening from the passenger
Open the fuel filler flap using the button on the the cap slowly. compartment is not possible.
lighting panel. The filler flap is located on the
right-hand rear wing, as indicated by the sym- After refuelling, refit the cap and turn it until one 1. Open the side hatch in the cargo area
or more clicking sounds are heard. (same side as fuel filler flap).
bol's arrow in the information display.
2. Locate the green cord with handle.
Close the fuel filler flap by pressing it in until a Filling up with fuel
Do not overfill the tank but fill until the pump 3. Pull it straight back until the fuel filler flap
click confirms that it is closed. folds out with a "click".
nozzle cuts out.

NOTE
Excess fuel in the tank can overflow in hot
weather.

208
05 During your journey

Fuel

General information on fuel IMPORTANT IMPORTANT


Fuel of a lower quality than that recommended
by Volvo must not be used as engine power
Mixing different types of fuel or the use of • Always refuel with unleaded petrol so as
fuel not recommended invalidates Volvo's not to damage the catalytic converter.
and fuel consumption is negatively affected. guarantees, and any associated service
agreement. This applies to all engines. • Do not use additives not recommended
NOTE: It does not apply to cars with engines by Volvo.
WARNING
that are adapted to run on ethanol fuel (E85).
Always avoid inhaling fuel fumes and fuel
splashing in the eyes. Catalytic converters
NOTE The purpose of the catalytic converters is to
If fuel gets into your eyes, take out contact purify exhaust gases. They are located close to
lenses if worn and rinse your eyes with Extreme weather conditions, driving with a the engine so that operating temperature is
plenty of water for at least 15 minutes and trailer or driving at high altitudes in combi-
seek medical attention. reached quickly.
nation with fuel grade are factors that could
Never swallow fuel. Fuels such as petrol, affect the car's performance. The catalytic converters consist of a monolith
bioethanol and mixtures of the two, as well (ceramic or metal) with channels. The channel
as diesel, are highly toxic and could cause walls are lined with a thin layer of platinum/rho- 05
permanent injury or be fatal if swallowed. Petrol dium/palladium. These metals act as catalysts,
Seek medical attention immediately if fuel Petrol must meet the EN 228 standard. Most i.e. they participate in and accelerate a chem-
has been swallowed. engines can be run with octane ratings of 95 ical reaction without being used up them-
and 98 RON. 91 RON should only be used in selves.
WARNING exceptional cases.
Lambda-sondTM oxygen sensor
Fuel which spills onto the ground can be • 95 RON can be used for normal driving. The Lambda-sond is part of a control system
ignited. • 98 RON is recommended for optimum per- intended to reduce emissions and improve fuel
Switch off the fuel-driven heater before star- formance and minimum fuel consumption. economy.
ting to refuel. When driving in temperatures above +38 °C, An oxygen sensor monitors the oxygen content
Never carry an activated mobile phone fuel with the highest possible octane rating is of the exhaust gases leaving the engine. This
when refuelling. The ring signal could cause recommended for optimum performance and value is fed into an electronic system that con-
spark build-up and ignite petrol fumes, fuel economy. tinuously controls the injectors. The ratio of fuel
leading to fire and injury. to air directed to the engine is continuously
adjusted. These adjustments create optimal
conditions for efficient combustion, and

``

209
05 During your journey

Fuel

together with the three-way catalytic converter IMPORTANT 1. Add at least 5 litres of diesel to the fuel
reduce harmful emissions (hydrocarbons, car- tank.
bon monoxide and nitrous oxides). Only ever use fuel that fulfils the European
diesel standard. 2. Place the remote key in the ignition switch
and push it gently so that it is pulled in (see
The sulphur content must be a maximum of page 73).
Diesel 50 ppm.
Diesel must fulfil the EN 590 or JIS K2204 3. Press the START button without depress-
standards. Diesel engines are sensitive to con- ing the brake and/or clutch pedal.
taminants, such as excessively high volumes IMPORTANT 4. Wait approx. 1 minute.
of sulphur particles for example. Only use die- Diesel type fuels which must not be used: 5. To start the engine: Depress the brake and/
sel fuel from well-known producers. Never use or clutch pedal and then press the
diesel of dubious quality. • Special additives
START button again.
At low temperatures (-6 °C to -40 °C), a paraffin
• Marine Diesel Fuel
• Fuel oil Draining condensation from the fuel filter
precipitate may form in the diesel fuel, which
The fuel filter separates condensation from the
may lead to ignition problems. Special diesel • RME1 (Rape Methyl Ester) and vegeta-
fuel. Condensation can disrupt engine opera-
05 fuel designed for low temperatures around ble oil.
tion.
freezing point is available from the major oil These fuels do not fulfil the requirements in
companies. This fuel is less viscous at low tem- accordance with Volvo recommendations The fuel filter must be drained at the intervals
peratures and reduces the risk of paraffin pre- and generate increased wear and engine specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet
cipitate. damage that is not covered by the Volvo or if you suspect that the car has been filled
warranty. with contaminated fuel.
The risk of condensation in the fuel tank is
reduced if the tank is kept well filled. When
refuelling, check that the area around the fuel Empty tank IMPORTANT
filler pipe is clean. Avoid spilling fuel onto the Once the engine has stopped due to fuel star- Certain special additives remove the water
paintwork. Wash off any spillage with deter- vation, the fuel system needs a few moments separation in the fuel filter.
gent and water. to carry out a check. Proceed as follows before
starting the engine:
Diesel particle filter (DPF)
Diesel cars are equipped with a particle filter,
which results in more efficient emission con-

1 Diesel fuel may contain a certain amount of RME, but further amounts must not be added.

210
05 During your journey

Fuel

trol. The particles in the exhaust gases are col- When regeneration is complete the warning NOTE
lected in the filter during normal driving. So- text is cleared automatically.
called "regeneration" is started in order to burn Extreme weather conditions, towing a trailer
Use the parking heater* in cold weather so that or driving at high altitudes in combination
away the particles and empty the filter. This
the engine reaches normal operating tempera- with fuel grade are factors that could affect
requires the engine to have reached normal the car's performance.
ture more quickly.
operating temperature.
Regeneration of the filter takes place automat- IMPORTANT
ically at an interval of approximately
300-900 km depending on driving conditions. If the filter fills up with particles then it can
be difficult to start the engine and the filter
Regeneration normally takes 10-20 minutes. It will be incapable of functioning. Then there
may take a little longer at a low average speed. is a risk that the filter will have to be
Fuel consumption may increase slightly during replaced.
regeneration.
Regeneration in cold weather
Fuel consumption and emissions of
If the car is frequently driven short distances in 05
carbon dioxide
cold weather then the engine does not reach
normal operating temperature. This means that Fuel consumption figures may change if the car
regeneration of the diesel particle filter does is equipped with extra equipment that affects
not take place and the filter is not emptied. the car's weight. See information on weights
page 274 and table page 282.
When the filter has become approximately
80% full of particles, a warning triangle on the The manner in which the car is driven, and
instrument panel illuminates, and the message other non-technical factors can also affect fuel
Soot filter full. See manual is shown on the consumption.
instrument panel display. Consumption is higher and power output lower
Start regeneration of the filter by driving the car for fuel with an octane rating of 91 RON.
until the engine reaches normal operating tem-
perature, preferably on a main road or motor-
way. The car should then be driven for approx-
imately ca 20 minutes more.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 211


05 During your journey

Loading

General WARNING Lowering the rear seat backrest


Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The To simplify loading in the cargo area, the rear
A loose object weighing 20 kg can, in a
total of the weight of the passengers and all frontal collision at a speed of 50 km/h, carry seats of the car can be folded down, see
accessories reduces the car's payload by a the impact of an item weighing 1000 kg. page 77.
corresponding weight. For more detailed infor-
Always secure the load.
mation on weights, see page 274.
Securing loads
WARNING WARNING
The car's driving characteristics change The protection provided by the inflatable
depending on the weight and distribution of curtain in the headlining may be compro-
the load. mised or eliminated by high loads. Never
load cargo above the backrest. During
heavy braking the load may otherwise shift,
Loading the cargo area causing injury to the car's occupants.
The boot lid can be opened via a but-
05 ton on the lighting panel or the
remote control key, see page 54. WARNING
• Position the load firmly against the back- Always secure the load. During heavy brak-
rest in front. ing the load may otherwise shift, causing
injury to the car's occupants. Each corner of the cargo area has attachment
• Put wide loads in the centre.
Protect sharp edges with something soft. points intended for the anchorage of loads.
• Heavy objects should be placed as low as
possible. Turn off the engine and apply the parking
brake when loading or unloading long WARNING
• Cover sharp edges with something soft to objects. Otherwise you may accidentally
avoid damaging the upholstery. knock the gear lever or gear selector with Hard, sharp and/or heavy objects that are
the load and cause a gear to engage and the loose or protrude could cause injury during
• Secure all loads to the load retaining eye-
heavy braking.
lets with straps or web lashings. car to move off.
Always secure large and heavy objects with
a seatbelt or cargo retaining straps.

212
05 During your journey

Cargo area

Bag holder* Safety net* WARNING


Loads in the cargo area must be firmly
secured, even if the safety net is correctly
fitted.

Installation

NOTE
The safety net is most easily fitted via one of
the rear doors.

G017745

G034213
Bag holder under folding hatch in the floor. The safety net is fitted into four mounting points. WARNING
The bag holder keeps carrier bags in place and A safety net prevents loads or pets from being Make sure that the upper mountings of the
safety net are correctly fitted and that the 05
prevents them from overturning and spreading thrown forward in the passenger compartment
anchoring straps are securely fastened.
their contents across the cargo area. in the event of sudden braking. For safety rea-
sons, the safety net must always be correctly Do not use a damaged net.
1. Open the hatch that is part of the floor in
fastened and secured.
the cargo area.
The net is made of a strong nylon fabric and 1. Unfold the safety net and make sure that
2. Tension and secure the carrier bags using the split upper rod is locked in extended
can be secured two different locations in the
the strap. position.
car:
• Rear fitting - Behind the rear seat backrest 2. Hook one end of the rod into the front or
rear roof mounting with the anchoring strap
• Front fitting - Behind the front seat backr-
locks turned towards you.
ests.
3. Hook the other end of the rod into the roof
mounting on the opposite side - the tele-
scopic spring-loaded retaining hooks facil-
itate alignment.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 213


05 During your journey

Cargo area

Take care to press forward the rod's retain- IMPORTANT


ing hooks for each respective roof moun-
ting's front end position. If the seat/backrest is pressed hard back-
wards against the safety net then the net
and/or its roof mountings could be dam-
aged.

5. Tension the safety net with the anchoring


straps.

Removal and storage

Front fitting.

Front fitting: With the net fitted in the front


05 roof mountings, hook the safety net's
Rear fitting. anchoring straps into the eyes on the rear
4. Rear fitting: With the net fitted in the rear of the seat slide rails - it is easier if the
roof mountings, hook the safety net's backrests are straightened and the seats
anchoring straps into the front floor eyes in are moved forward slightly.
the cargo area.
Pay attention to make sure that you do not
press the seat/backrest hard against the
net when the seat/backrest is moved back The safety net can be easily removed and folded
again - only adjust until the seat/backrest up.
makes contact with the net.
Release the tension in the net by pressing
in the button on the anchoring strap's lock
and feeding out part of the strap.
Press in the catch and detach both of the
anchoring strap's hooks.

214
05 During your journey

Cargo area

Break the rod in the centre, fold it together IMPORTANT


and roll up the net.
The safety grille cannot be folded up or
The folded safety net can be stored under the down when a cargo cover is fitted.
cargo compartment floor.
Installation
Safety grille*

G018369
NOTE
The safety grille is most easily fitted and
removed by two people via the rear doors.

G018367
When fitting, the handle, see
illustration – , must be on the front of 05
the grille.
G031978

The backrests must be lowered to allow the


A safety grille prevents loads or pets from safety grille to be fitted, see page 77.
being thrown forward in the passenger com- Position the handle in fitting position, see
partment in the event of sudden braking. For illustration. Press gently on the handle to

G018368
safety reasons, the grille must always be enable it to be turned into position, see
mounted and secured correctly. arrow.
Folding up Press the strut in towards the grille and
Take hold of the bottom of the safety grille and align the grille in the roof mounting.
pull back/up. Turn the handle 90° . Press gently as in
the illustration (1) if necessary. Secure the
grille by angling the handle 90° .

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 215


05 During your journey

Cargo area

Removal Move the other end piece into the corres- Roof load
Removal of the grille takes place in reverse ponding recess.
order to the description in the related section Using load carriers
Press both sides in. A "click" should be To avoid damaging the car and for maximum
entitled "Installation". audible and the red marking should disap- possible safety while driving, the load carriers
pear. designed by Volvo are recommended.
Cargo cover* > Check that both end pieces are locked.
Carefully follow the installation instructions
Removing the cargo cover supplied with the carriers.
1. Press in one end piece button and lift it out. • Check periodically that the load carriers
2. Carefully angle the cover up/out and the and load are properly secured. Lash the
other end piece loosens automatically. load securely with retaining straps.
• Distribute the load evenly over the load
Lowering the cargo cover's rear sealing carriers. Put the heaviest objects at the
disc bottom.
05 In its rolled-in position, the cargo cover's rear • The size of the area exposed to the wind,
G031977
sealing disc protrudes horizontally into the and therefore fuel consumption, increase
cargo area when it is fitted. with the size of the load.
± Pull the sealing disc back gently, free from • Drive gently. Avoid quick acceleration,
Pull the cargo cover over the load and hook it its support shelves, and lower. heavy braking and hard cornering.
into the holes by the rear pillars in the cargo
area. Long load WARNING
The passenger seat backrest can also be The car's centre of gravity and driving cha-
IMPORTANT folded for an extra long load, see page 75. racteristics are altered by roof loads.
The safety grille cannot be folded up or For information on maximum permitted roof
down when the cargo cover is fitted. load, including load carriers and any space
box, see page 274.
Fitting the cargo cover
Move one end piece of the cover into the
recess on the side panel.

216 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 During your journey

Warning triangle*

Take the warning triangle from the case,


fold out and assemble the two loose sides.
Fold out the warning triangle's support
legs.
Follow the regulations for the use of a warning
triangle. Position the warning triangle in a suit-
able place with regard to traffic.
Ensure the warning triangle and its case are
properly secured in the cargo area after use.

First aid*

05

A case with first aid equipment is located under


the floor in the cargo area.

Lift the floor mat and take out the warning


triangle.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 217


05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

General • The engine is loaded more heavily than • Move the gear selector to position P when
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The usual when driving with a trailer. parking an automatic car with a hitched
total of the weight of the passengers and all • If the car is driven with a heavy load in a hot trailer. Always use the parking brake. Block
accessories, e.g. towbar, reduces the car's climate, the engine may overheat. If the the wheels with chocks when parking a car
temperature in the engine's cooling system with hitched trailer on a hill.
payload by a corresponding weight. For more
detailed information on weights, see is too high the warning symbol is illumi-
Trailer cable
page 274. nated and the information display shows
An adapter is required if the car's towing
High engine temp Stop safely. Stop the
If the towing bracket is mounted by Volvo, then car in a safe way and allow the engine to bracket has 13 pin electrics and the trailer has
the car is delivered with the necessary equip- run at idling speed for several minutes and 7 pin electrics. Use an adapter cable approved
ment for driving with a trailer. cool down. If High engine temp Stop by Volvo. Make sure the cable does not drag
engine or Coolant level low, Stop on the ground.
• The car's towing bracket must be of an
approved type. engine are shown then the engine must be
Direction indicators and brake lights on
switched off after stopping the car.
• If the towbar is retrofitted, check with your the trailer
Volvo dealer that the car is fully equipped • The automatic gearbox has a built-in pro- If any of the trailer's lamps for direction indica-
05 for driving with a trailer. tection system that engages in the event of tors are broken, then the combined instrument
overheating. If the temperature in the gear- panel's symbol for direction indicators flashes
• Distribute the load on the trailer so that the
box is too high the warning symbol is illu-
weight on the towing bracket complies faster than normal and the display shows the
minated and the information display shows
with the specified maximum towball load. text Bulb fail - Ind. signal trailer.
Transmission hot Reduce speed or
• Increase the tyre pressure to the recom- Transmission hot Stop safely. Follow If any of the trailer's lamps for the brake light
mended pressure for a full load. For tyre the instructions and reduce speed or stop are broken then the Bulb fail - Stop lamp
pressure label location, see page 263. the car in a safe way and allow the engine trailer text is shown.
• Clean the towing bracket regularly and to run at idling speed for several minutes to
grease the towball. enable the gearbox to cool down. In the Automatic gearbox
event of overheating the car's air condi-
• Do not tow a heavy trailer when the car is
tioning may be temporarily switched off.
Parking on a hill
brand new. Wait until it has been driven at 1. Activate the parking brake.
least 1000 km. • In the interests of safety, you should
restrict speed to 80 km/h, even if the laws 2. Move the gear selector to position P.
• The brakes are loaded much more than
of certain countries allow for higher
usual on long and steep downhill slopes. Starting on a hill
Downshift to a lower gear and adjust your speeds. 1. Move the gear selector to position D.
speed. 2. Release the parking brake.

218
05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

Steep inclines Towing bracket Storing the towball section


• Do not use a higher manual gear than the If the car is equipped with a detachable towbar,
engine can "handle". It is not always eco- the towball mounting instructions must be fol-
nomical to drive in high gears. lowed carefully, see page 220.
• Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines of
more than 12%. WARNING
Level control If the car is fitted with a Volvo detachable
The rear shock absorbers maintain a constant towbar:
height irrespective of the car's load (up to the • Follow the assembly instructions for the
maximum permissible weight). When the car is towball section carefully.

G031713
stationary the rear of the car lowers slightly,
• The towball section must be locked with
which is normal. the key before setting off.
Towball section storage location.
Trailer weights • Check that the indicator window shows
National vehicle regulations can limit trailer green.
IMPORTANT 05
weights and speeds. The towbar can be certi-
fied for a higher towing weight than the car can Important checks Always remove the towball section after use
actually tow. For Volvo's permitted trailer and store it in the appointed location in the
• The towball section's towball must be
car, firmly fastened with its strap.
weights, see page 276. cleaned and greased regularly.

WARNING NOTE
Follow the stated recommendations for If a towball hitch with vibration damper is
trailer weights. Otherwise, the car and trailer used, it is not necessary to grease the tow-
may be difficult to control in the event of ball.
sudden movement and braking.

``

219
05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

Specifications Installing the towball

G018928
G021485
Remove the protective cover by first press-
ing in the catch and then pulling the
Dimensions, mounting points (mm) cover straight back .

05 A 1013

B 69

C 855

D 428

G021487
E 109

F 296
Ensure that the mechanism is in the
G Side member unlocked position by turning the key clock-
H Ball centre wise.

220
05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

G021488

G021490

G021494
The indicator window must show red. The indicator window must show green. Check that the towball section is secure by
pulling it up, down and back.

WARNING
If the towball section is not fitted correctly
then it must be removed and refitted in 05
accordance with the previous instructions.
G021489

G000000
IMPORTANT
Only grease in the ball for the towing hitch,
Insert the towball section until you hear a Turn the key anticlockwise to locked posi- the remainder of the towball section should
click. tion. Remove the key from the lock. be clean and dry.

``

221
05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

G021495

G018929
Safety cable. Push in the locking wheel and turn it Push the protective cover until it snaps
anticlockwise until you hear a click. tight.
WARNING
Trailer Stability Assist - TSA
Be sure to attach the trailer's safety cable to
the correct place. The TSA system (Trailer Stability Assist) serves
05 to stabilise the car and trailer combination if it
begins to snake.
The TSA function is part of the DSTC system
Removing the towball
(Dynamic Stability and Traction Control), see
page 152.

Function
Turn the locking wheel down fully, until it The snaking phenomenon can occur with any
comes to a stop. Hold it in this position car/trailer combination. Normally, snaking
while pulling the towball rearward and occurs at extremely high speeds. But, there is
upward. a risk of it occurring at lower speeds
(70-90 km/h) if the trailer is overloaded or the
WARNING load is improperly distributed, e.g. too far back.
Insert the key and turn it clockwise to the Secure the towbar's loose towball safely if In order for snaking to occur, there must be a
it is stored in the car, see page 219. triggering factor, e.g.:
unlocked position.

222
05 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

• Car with trailer subjected to a sudden and NOTE


powerful side wind.
If the driver selects to switch off (reduce) the
• Car with trailer drives on an uneven road DSTC system, then the TSA system is also
surface or in a pothole. switched off, see page 152.
• Sweeping steering wheel movements.

Operation TSA may fail to engage if the driver uses severe


If snaking has started, it could be difficult or steering wheel movements to try to rectify the
even impossible to suppress. This makes the snaking because in such a situation the TSA
car/trailer combination difficult to control and system cannot determine whether it is the
there is a risk that you could, for example, end trailer or the driver that is causing the snaking.
up in the wrong lane or leave the carriageway. The DSTC symbol in the combined
TSA system continually monitors car move- instrument panel flashes when the
ments, particularly lateral movements. If snak- TSA is working.
ing is detected, the front wheels are individually 05
braked. This serves to stabilise the car/trailer
combination. This is often enough to help the
driver regain control of the car.
If snaking is not eliminated the first time the
TSA system comes into action, the car/trailer
combination is braked with all wheels and
engine power is reduced. Once snaking has
been gradually suppressed and the car/trailer
combination is once again stable, the TSA sys-
tem stops regulating and the driver once again
has full control of the car.

Miscellaneous
The TSA system can engage within the speed
interval 60 to 160 km/h.

223
05 During your journey

Towing and recovery

Towing WARNING IMPORTANT


Find out the highest legal speed for towing
The brake servo and power steering do not Bump starting the car can damage the cat-
before towing the car. work when the engine is switched off. The alytic converter.
1. Press the remote control key into the igni- brake pedal must be pressed about five
tion switch to unlock the steering lock so times harder than normal, and the steering
will be considerably heavier than normal. Towing eye
that the car can be steered, see page 73.
Use the towing eye if the car needs to be towed
2. The remote control key must remain in the
Manual gearbox on the road. The towing eye is attached in the
ignition switch while the car is being towed.
± Move gear lever into neutral and release recess on the right-hand side of the front or
3. Ensure the towrope is always taut by gently the parking brake. rear bumper.
depressing the brake pedal to avoid violent
jerks. Automatic gearbox Fitting the towing eye
± Move the gear selector to position N and
4. Be prepared to brake to stop.
release the parking brake.
05 WARNING IMPORTANT
Insert the remote control key in the ignition
Note that the car must always be towed with
switch to unlock the steering lock (so that
the wheels rolling forward.
the car can be steered) before towing.
• Cars with automatic gearbox must not
be towed at speeds above 80 km/h or
WARNING further than 80 km.
The steering lock remains in the position it Take out the towing eye from its storage
was in when the power was cut off. The space under the floor hatch in the cargo
Jump starting area.
steering lock must be unlocked before tow-
ing. The remote control key must be in key Do not tow the car to bump start it. Use a donor
battery if the battery is discharged to the extent > In some cases, the towing eye may be
position II. Never remove the remote control hidden under the sill.
key from the ignition switch while driving or that the engine does not start, see page 102.
when the car is being towed.

224
05 During your journey

Towing and recovery

Recovery

IMPORTANT
Note that the car must always be towed with
the wheels rolling forward.
• An all-wheel drive car (AWD) with raised
front suspension must not be towed at
speeds above 70 km/h. It should not be
towed further than 50 km.

WARNING
Use a slotted screwdriver or a coin to The towing eye is only designed for towing
detach the cover at its bottom edge. on roads - not for recovering the car. Call a
recovery service for recovery assistance.
Screw in the towing eye firmly, right in up 05
to the flange. Use the wheel wrench to
tighten the towing eye.

NOTE
On certain cars with fitted towbar the towing
eye cannot be secured in the rear mounting.
In which case, secure the tow rope in the
towbar.
For this reason it is advisable to store a
detachable towbar towball in the car.

225
Engine compartment............................................................................. 228
Lamps................................................................................................... 234
Wiper blades and washer fluid.............................................................. 241
Battery................................................................................................... 243
Fuses..................................................................................................... 246
Wheels and tyres.................................................................................. 254

G020922
Car care................................................................................................ 265

226
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE

06
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

General WARNING If the car is raised with a workshop jack; posi-


tion the jack against the front edge on the
Volvo service programme Bear in mind that the radiator fan may start engine's subframe.
To keep the car as safe and reliable as possi- automatically some time after the engine
ble, follow the Volvo service programme as has been switched off. Do not damage the splashguard under the
specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Always have the engine cleaned by a work- engine. Ensure that the workshop jack is posi-
Volvo recommends engaging an authorised shop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is tioned so that the car cannot slide off the jack.
Volvo workshop to perform the service and hot. Always use axle stands or similar.
maintenance work. Volvo workshops have the If you raise the car using a two-pillar workshop
personnel, special tools and service literature Raising the car lift, ensure that the front and rear lift arms are
to guarantee the highest quality of service. fixed under the lifting points on the door sill.
NOTE See preceding illustration.
IMPORTANT
Volvo recommends only using the jack that
For the Volvo warranty to apply, check and belongs to the car model in question. If a Opening and closing the bonnet
follow the instructions in the Service and jack other than one recommended by Volvo
Warranty Booklet. is selected, then follow the instructions
included with the equipment.
Check regularly
Check the following oils and fluids at regular
06 intervals, e.g. when refuelling:
• Coolant
• Engine oil
• Power steering fluid
• Washer fluid

228
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

Engine compartment, overview WARNING


High voltage output from the ignition sys-
tem. The voltage in the ignition system is
highly dangerous. The remote control key
must therefore always be in position 0 dur-
ing work in the engine compartment, see
page 73.

G031911
Do not touch the spark plugs or ignition coils
when the remote control key is in ignition
position II or when the engine is hot.
Pull the handle by the pedals. An informa-
tion symbol lights when the bonnet is open,
see page 68.
Checking the engine oil
Move the catch to the left and open the The appearance of the engine compartment may
bonnet. (The catch hook is located vary depending on engine variant.
between the headlamp and grille, see illus- Coolant expansion tank
tration.)
Power steering fluid reservoir
WARNING Engine oil dipstick
Check that the bonnet locks properly when 06
closed. Radiator
Filler opening for engine oil

G021733
Brake and clutch fluid reservoir (left-hand
drive)
Label for oil grade.
Battery
Volvo recommends Castrol oil products.
Relay and fuse box, engine compartment
When driving under adverse conditions, see
Filling washer fluid page 280.
Air filter

``

229
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

IMPORTANT Filling and dipstick IMPORTANT


In order to fulfil the requirements for the When filling oil to top up, the oil being filled
engine's service intervals all engines are must have the same grade, see page 280.
filled with a specially adapted synthetic
engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil
has been made very carefully with regard to Checking the oil level in a new car is especially
service life, starting characteristics, fuel important before the first scheduled oil change.
consumption and environmental impact. An The most accurate measurements are made on
approved engine oil must be used in order
a cold engine before starting. The measure-
that the recommended service intervals can
be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of ment will be inaccurate if taken immediately
oil (see the engine compartment decal) for after the engine is switched off. The dipstick
both filling and oil change, otherwise you will indicate that the level is too low because
will risk affecting service life, starting cha- the oil has not had time to flow down into the
racteristics, fuel consumption and environ- Petrol engine. oil sump.
mental impact. Volvo Car Corporation dis-
claims all warranty liability if engine oil of the
prescribed grade and viscosity is not used.

Volvo uses different systems for warning of low


06 oil level or low oil pressure. Certain variants
have an oil pressure sensor, and then the lamp
for oil pressure is used. Other variants have an
oil level sensor, and then the driver is informed
via the warning symbol in the centre of the
instrument unit as well as by display texts. Cer-

G021737
tain models have both variants. Contact a
Volvo dealer for more information.
Diesel engine. The oil level must be within the area marked on the
Change in accordance with the intervals speci- dipstick.
fied in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Park the car on a level surface, switch off the
engine and wait 10-15 minutes to allow the oil

230
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

time to run back to the sump. For capacities, Coolant IMPORTANT


see page 280 and onwards.
Checking and topping up the coolant • A high content of chlorine, chlorides
Checking with a cold engine and other salts may cause corrosion in
1. Wipe the dipstick clean. the cooling system.
2. Check the level using the dipstick. It must • Always use coolant with anti-corrosion
be between the MIN and MAX marks. agent as recommended by Volvo.
3. If the level is close to the MIN mark, start • Ensure that the coolant mixture is 50%
by topping up with 0.5 litres of oil. Top up water and 50% coolant.
until the level is nearer to MAX than MIN • Mix the coolant with approved quality
on the dipstick. tap water. In the event of any doubt
about water quality, used ready-mixed
IMPORTANT coolant in accordance with Volvo rec-
ommendations.
Never fill above the MAX mark. Oil con-
sumption may increase if too much oil is • When changing coolant/replacing cool-
poured into the engine. When topping up the coolant, follow the ing system components, flush the cool-
instructions on the packaging. It is important ing system clean with approved quality
that the mixture of coolant concentrate and tap water or flush with ready-mixed
WARNING water is correct for the prevailing weather con- coolant.
Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold ditions. Never top up with water only. The risk • The engine must only be run with a well- 06
due to the risk of fire. of freezing increases with both too little and too filled cooling system. High tempera-
much coolant concentrate. For capacities, see tures can occur, causing a risk of dam-
page 280. age (cracks) to the cylinder head.
Checking with a warm engine
1. Wipe the dipstick clean.
For capacities and for standards regarding
2. Check the oil level using the dipstick. water quality, see page 280.
3. If the level is close to the MIN mark, start
Check the coolant regularly
by topping up with 0.5 litres of oil. Top up
The level must lie between the MIN and MAX
until the level is nearer to MAX than MIN
marks on the expansion tank. If the system is
on the dipstick.

``

231
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

not filled sufficiently, high temperatures could WARNING 2. Unscrew the reservoir cap and fill the fluid.
occur, causing a risk of damage to the engine. The level must be between the MIN and
If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the MAX marks, which are located on the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
WARNING inside of the reservoir.
before topping up the brake fluid. Volvo rec-
Coolant can be very hot. If the coolant ommends that the reason for the loss of
requires topping up when the engine is at brake fluid is investigated by an authorised IMPORTANT
operating temperature, unscrew the expan- Volvo workshop.
Do not forget to refit the cap.
sion tank cap slowly to gently release the
overpressure. Filling
Power steering fluid
Brake and clutch fluid
Checking the level
Brake and clutch fluid have a common reser-
voir. The level must be between the MIN and
MAX marks that are visible inside the reservoir.
Check the level regularly.
Change the brake fluid every other year or at
06 every other regular service.
For capacities and recommended fluid grade,
see page 280. The fluid should be changed The fluid reservoir is located on the driver's side.
annually on cars driven in conditions requiring The fluid reservoir is protected under the cover
hard, frequent braking, such as driving in over the cold section in the engine compart- IMPORTANT
mountains or tropical climates with high ment. The round cover must be removed first
humidity. Keep the area around the power steering
before the reservoir cap can be reached. fluid reservoir clean when checking.
1. Turn and open the cover located on the
covering. Check the level frequently. The fluid does not
require changing. The fluid level must be

232
06 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

between the MIN and MAX marks. For capaci-


ties and recommended fluid grade, see
page 280.

NOTE
If a fault should arise in the power steering
system or if the engine is switched off and
the car must be towed, it can still be steered.

06

233
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

General Front lamp housing Removing the headlamp


All bulbs are specified, see page 240. Bulbs 1. Press quickly on the START-/STOP
and spotlights that are of a special type or that ENGINE button and remove the remote
are only suitable for replacement by a work- control key.
shop are: 2. (Upper illustration)
• General interior lighting in the roof, reading
Withdraw the lamp housing's locking
lamps
pins.
• Glovebox lighting
Pull the lamp housing straight forward.
• Direction indicators, door mirror
• Approach lighting
IMPORTANT
• Brake light, fog lamp, reversing lamp
Do not pull the electrical cable, only the con-
• Rear side position lamps, position lamps nector.
• Xenon, Active Xenon lamps
• LED lamps, general 3. (Lower illustration)
Detach the lamp housing connector by
WARNING
pressing down the clip with your thumb.
06 On cars with Dual Xenon headlamps, Dual
Xenon lamp replacement must be carried At the same time, guide out the con-
out at a workshop - an authorised Volvo All front bulbs (except those for fog lamps) are nector with your other hand.
workshop is recommended. The headlamps replaced by first removing the whole lamp
must be handled with extreme caution due housing from the engine compartment. 4. Lift out the lamp housing and place it on a
to the Dual Xenon lamp's high-voltage unit. soft surface to avoid scratching the lens.
WARNING 5. Replace the bulb in question, see
IMPORTANT Always switch off the ignition and remove page 240.
the remote control key before starting to
Never touch the glass part of the bulbs with
replace a bulb.
your fingers. Grease and oils from your fin-
gers are vaporised by the heat, coating the
reflector and then causing damage.

234
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Installing the headlamp Removing the cover Dipped beam, halogen

When installing, check that the long lock pin is Before starting to replace a bulb, see 1. Detach the headlamp.
engaged - it should be engaged in both eyes. page 234.
2. Remove the cover.
1. Plug in the connector, a clicking sound 1. Release the catches by pressing out.
should be heard. 3. Detach the bulb by pressing the holder
2. Remove the cover by pulling it straight out. downwards.
2. Reinstall the lamp housing and locking
pins. Check that they are correctly Reinstall the cover in reverse order. 4. Unplug the connector from the bulb. 06
inserted. 5. Fit the new bulb in the socket and snap it
3. Check the lighting. in. It can only be secured in one position.

The lamp housing must be plugged in and Reinstall the parts in reverse order.
installed before the lighting is switched on or
the remote control key is inserted into the igni-
tion switch.

``

235
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Main beam, Halogen Extra main beam, Xenon* Direction indicators/flashers

1. Detach the headlamp. 1. Detach the headlamp. 1. Detach the headlamp.


2. Remove the cover. 2. Remove the cover, see page 235. 2. Detach the bulb holder by turning anti-
clockwise.
3. Detach the bulb by turning anticlockwise 3. Unplug the connector from the bulb.
and then pulling straight out 3. Pull the bulb holder in order to extract the
4. Detach the bulb holder by pulling it straight
bulb.
06 4. Unplug the connector from the bulb. out.
4. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in
5. Replace the bulb and align it in the socket 5. Replace the bulb and fit the new one in the
and turning anticlockwise.
and turn clockwise in order to secure it. It socket. It can only be secured in one posi-
can only be secured in one position. tion. 5. Fit a new bulb, press down and turn clock-
wise.
Reinstall the parts in reverse order. Reinstall the parts in reverse order.
6. Fit the bulb holder and turn clockwise.
Reinstall the parts in reverse order.

236 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Side marker lamps Front fog lamps Rear fog lamp

Before starting to replace a bulb, see Undo the cover by pulling out the top corner, The rear fog lamp is accessed behind the
page 234. closest to the grille, see the illustration above. bumper
1. Detach the headlamp. 1. Pull the cover straight out in the direction 1. Detach the bulb holder by turning anti-
of the centre of the car using a tool, see the clockwise.
2. Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise and
illustration above.
remove it. 2. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in
> (Secure the tool (1) and pull straight out and turning anticlockwise. 06
3. Remove the blown bulb and fit a new one. (2).)
It can only be installed in one way. 3. Fit a new bulb, press down and turn clock-
2. Unscrew the lamp housing screw and wise.
4. Fit the bulb holder in the socket and turn remove the fog lamp.
clockwise. 4. Fit the bulb holder and turn clockwise.
3. Turn the bulb anticlockwise and remove it.
Reinstall the parts in reverse order.
4. Fit a new bulb and turn clockwise.
5. Refit the bulb holder. The TOP mark on the
bulb holder must always be upward.

``

237
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Location of rear bulbs Brake lights and reversing lamps Number plate lighting

Lamp lens, right-hand side


Both the brake light and the reversing lamp 1. Remove the screws with a screwdriver.
Position (LED)/side marker lamps bulbs are replaced from inside the cargo area.
2. Carefully detach the entire lamp housing
Side reflector, rear 1. Open the panel. and withdraw it.
Brake light 2. Detach the bulb holder by turning anti- 3. Replace the bulb.
clockwise.
06 Reversing lamp 4. Refit the entire lamp housing and screw it
3. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in into place.
Indicator and turning anticlockwise.
Brake light (LED) 4. Fit a new bulb, press down and turn clock-
wise.
5. Fit the bulb holder and turn clockwise.

238
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Courtesy lighting Lighting, cargo area Vanity mirror lighting


Removing the mirror glass

G031942
Before starting to replace a bulb, see 1. Insert a screwdriver and gently prize so
page 234. that the lamp housing comes loose.
1. Insert a screwdriver underneath the lower
1. Insert a screwdriver at the short end of the 2. Replace the bulb. edge, in the centre. Carefully prize up the
lens closest to the tunnel console and turn lug on the edge.
3. Check that the bulb illuminates and press
gently so that the lens comes loose.
back the lamp housing. 2. Insert the screwdriver underneath the edge
(Applies to both lamps). 06
on the left and right-hand sides (by the
2. Turn carefully until the lens comes loose. black rubber sections), and prize carefully
3. Replace the bulb. so that the glass comes loose in the lower
edge.
4. Refit the lens.
3. Carefully detach and lift aside the entire
mirror glass and cover.
4. Replace the bulb.

Fitting the mirror glass


1. Press the three lugs at top edge of the mir-
ror glass back into position.

``

239
06 Maintenance and service

Lamps

2. Then press the three lower lugs back into Lighting W Type
position.
Front side marker 5 W3WLL
Specification, bulbs lamps

Lighting W Type Glovebox lighting 5 Tubular


lamp
Extra main beam, 65 H9
SV8.5
Xenon, ABL

Dipped beam, hal- 55 H7 LL


ogen

Main beam, Halo- 65 H9


gen

Front direction 21 PY21W


indicators

Front fog lamps 35 H8

06 Courtesy lighting, 5 Tubular


cargo area lighting, lamp
number plate light-
SV8.5
ing

Vanity mirror 1.2 Tubular


lamp
SV5.5

240
06 Maintenance and service

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Wiper blades
Service position
In order to change, clean or lift the wiper blades
(for scraping off ice from the windscreen) they
must be in service position.
1. Turn the remote control key to position 0,
see page 73, and keep the remote control
key in the ignition switch.
2. Move the right-hand stalk switch up for

G021763
about 1 second. The wipers then move to
standing straight up.
The wipers return to the starting position when NOTE
the car is started.
The wiper blades are different lengths. The
Replacing the wiper blades blade on the driver's side is longer than the
blade on the passenger side.

Turn up the wiper arm. Press the button 06


located on the wiper blade mounting and
pull straight out parallel with the wiper arm.
Slide in the new wiper blade until a "click"
is heard.
Check that the blade is firmly installed.

``

241
06 Maintenance and service

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Replacing the wiper blades, rear window IMPORTANT


Check the wiper blades regularly.
Neglected maintenance shortens the serv-
ice life of the wiper blades.

Filling washer fluid

G032770
1. Fold out the wiper arm.
2. Grip the inner section of the blade (by the
arrow).
3. Turn anticlockwise to use the blade's end
position against the wiper arm as a lever to
06 detach the blade more easily.
The windscreen and headlamp washers share
4. Press the new wiper blade into position. a common reservoir.
Check that it is firmly installed.
5. Lower the wiper arm. IMPORTANT
Add washer antifreeze during the winter so
Cleaning that the fluid does not freeze in the pump,
For cleaning wiper blades and windscreen, see reservoir and hoses.
page 265.
For capacities, see page 280.

242
06 Maintenance and service

Battery

Warning symbols on the battery Avoid sparks and naked IMPORTANT


Use protective goggles. flames. Never use a quick charger to charge the
battery.

WARNING
Risk of explosion. Batteries can generate oxyhydrogen gas,
which is highly explosive. One spark, which
Further information in the can be generated if you connect jump leads
owner's manual. incorrectly, is sufficient to make the battery
explode. The battery contains sulphuric
acid, which can cause serious burns. If sul-
phuric acid comes into contact with eyes,
skin or clothing, flush with large quantities
NOTE of water. If acid splashes into the eyes, seek
Store the battery out of medical attention immediately.
the reach of children. An expended battery must be recycled in an
environmentally responsible manner - it
contains lead.

06
Operation
The battery contains cor- • Check that the cables to the battery are
rosive acid. correctly connected and properly tight-
ened.
• Never disconnect the battery when the
engine is running.
The service life and function of the battery is
influenced by factors such as the number of
starts, discharging, driving style, driving con-
ditions, climatic conditions etc.

``

243
06 Maintenance and service

Battery

NOTE Changing
The life of the battery is shortened if it Removal
becomes discharged repeatedly.
The life of the battery is affected by several
factors, including driving conditions and cli-
mate. Battery starting capacity decreases
gradually with time and therefore needs to
be recharged if the car is not used for a
longer time or when it is only driven short
distances. Extreme cold further limits star-
ting capacity.
To maintain the battery in good condition, at
least 15 minutes of driving/week is recom-
mended or that the battery is connected to
a battery charger with automatic trickle
charging.
A battery that is kept fully charged has a
maximum service life.

06 Switch off the ignition and wait for 5 minutes.


Open the clips on the front cover and
remove the cover.
Release the rubber moulding so that the
rear cover is free.
Remove the rear cover by screwing one
quarter turn and lifting it away.

244
06 Maintenance and service

Battery

WARNING 3. Screw in the battery with the screw in the


clamp.
Connect and disconnect the positive and
negative cables in the correct sequence. 4. Connect the ventilation hose.
5. Connect the red positive cable.
6. Connect the black negative cable.
Detach the black negative cable 7. Press in the rear cover. (See Removal).
Detach the red positive cable 8. Reinstall the rubber moulding. (See
Removal).
Detach the ventilation hose from the bat-
9. Reinstall the front cover and secure it with
tery
the clips. (See Removal).
Loosen the screw holding the battery
clamp.
Move the battery to the side and lift it up.

Installation

06

1. Lower the battery into the battery box.


2. Move the battery inward and to the side
until it reaches the rear edge of the box.

245
06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

General Location, fuse boxes


All electrical functions and components are
protected by a number of fuses in order to pro-
tect the car's electrical system from damage by
short circuiting or overloading.
If an electrical component or function does not
work, it may be because the component's fuse
was temporarily overloaded and failed. If the
same fuse fails repeatedly then there is a fault
in the circuit. Volvo recommends that you visit
an authorised Volvo workshop for checking.

Changing
1. Look in the fuse diagram to locate the fuse. Location of fuse boxes, left-hand drive.

2. Pull out the fuse and check from the side If the car is right-hand drive, the fuse box
to see whether the curved wire has blown. changes to under the side of the glovebox.
3. If this is the case, replace it with a new fuse Under the glovebox
of the same colour and amperage.
Engine compartment
06
WARNING Cargo area
Never use a foreign object, or a fuse with an
amperage higher than that specified when
replacing a fuse. This could cause signifi-
cant damage to the electrical system and
possibly lead to fire.

246
06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Engine compartment

06

``

247
06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

General fuses, engine compartment Function A Function A


On the inside of the cover are tweezers that
facilitate the removal and fitting of fuses. Primary fuse RJBD KL30 50 Speed related power 5
steering*
Positions (see preceding illustration) - -
Engine compartment, upper Engine Control Module 10
PTC Air preheater* 100 (ECM), transm. SRS
Engine compartment, front
- - Heated washer nozzles* 10
Engine compartment, lower
These fuses are all located in the engine com- Windscreen wipers 30 - -
partment box. Fuses in are located under
Parking heater* 25 Lighting panel 5
.
Ventilation fan 40 Headlamp washers* 15
• Fuses 1-7 and 42-44 are of the "Midi Fuse"
type and must only be replaced by a work-
shop. Volvo recommends an authorised - - 12 V socket, front and rear 15
Volvo workshop. seat
ABS pump 40
• 8-15 and 34 are of the "JCASE" type and Sunroof*, Roof console/ 5
the recommendation for changing is that ECC*
06 ABS valves 20
you visit an authorised Volvo workshop.
Relay, engine compart- 5
• 16 – 33 and 35 – 41 are of the "MiniFuse" - - ment box
type.
Headlamp levelling* 10 Auxiliary lamps* 20
Function A (Xenon, Dual Xenon)
Primary fuse CEM KL30A 50 Horn 15
Primary fuse CEM 20
Primary fuse CEM KL30B 50 Engine Control Module 10
Radar, ACC control mod- 5 (ECM)
ule*
Primary fuse RJBA KL30 60
Control module, auto- 15
Primary fuse RJBB KL30 60 matic gearbox*

248 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Function A Function A
Compressor A/C 15 Crankcase ventilation 10
heater (5-cyl. petrol)
Relay coils 5
- -
Starter motor relay 30
Diesel filter heater, crank- 20
Ignition coils 20 case ventilation heater (5-
cyl. diesel)
EGR, VTC, Glow system 10
(5-cyl. diesel), Bypass - -
engine cooling system (4-
cyl. diesel) Glow plugs (5-cyl. diesel) 70
Engine control module, 10 - -
Throttle petrol
15
Engine control module, Cooling fan (4 - 5-cyl. pet-
Throttle diesel rol)

Injection system, Mass air 15 80


06
flow sensor

Engine valves 10

EVAP, Lambda-sond, 15
Injection (petrol)
10
Lambda-sond (4-cyl. pet-
rol, 5-cyl. diesel)

``

249
06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Under the glovebox

1. Fold aside the interior trim covering the Function A Function A


fuse box.
2. Press the cover's lock and fold it up. Accelerator pedal, air 7,5 Sunroof* 20
06
heater (PTC)*, heated
3. The fuses are accessible. seats* Reversing lamps 7,5
Positions - - - -
Function A
ICM display, CD & RadioA 15 Fog lamp, front* 15
Rain sensor* 5
Steering wheel module 7,5 Windscreen washers 15
SRS system 10
- - Adaptive cruise control, 10
ABS brakes 5 ACC*
Main beam 15

250 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Function A
- -

Roof lighting, control panel 7,5


driver's door/Power pas-
senger seat*

Information display 5

Power driver's seat* 5

Windscreen wiper, rear 15

Remote control key 5


receiver, alarm sensors*

Fuel pump 20

Electric steering lock 20

- - 06

Lock, tank/tailgate 10

Alarm siren*, ECC 5

Start/stop button 5

Brake light switch 5


A Not Premium or High Performance.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 251


06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Cargo area

The fuse box is located behind the upholstery A A


(black) (black)
on the left-hand side.
Control panel, rear door, 25 Trailer socket 2* 15
06 Positions right
(black) A Power seat driver's side* 25
- -
Control panel, driver's door 25 Trailer socket 1* 40
12 V socket, cargo area, 15
Control panel, passenger 25 refrigerator* POT (automatic tailgate 30
door opening)*
Rear window defroster 30
Control panel, rear door, left 25
- -

252 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Fuses

(white) A (blue) A
Parking assistance*, Parking 5 Display RTI* 10
camera*
- -
Control module Four C* 15
Bass speaker* 25
Seat heating, driver's side 15
front* DAB radio 5
Seat heating, passenger side 15 Audio amplifier* 25
front*
Audio systemA 15
Seat heating right rear* 15
Phone, Bluetooth* 5
AWD control module 10
-
Seat heating left rear* 15
-
- -

Power seat passenger side* 25 06


A High Performance and Premium.

Keyless drive* 20

Electric parking brake, left 30

Electric parking brake, right 30

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 253


06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

General NOTE New tyres


Tyres greatly affect the car's driving characte-
Ensure that tyres of the same type and
ristics. The type of tyre, dimensions, tyre pres- dimensions, and also the same make, are
sure and speed rating are important for how the fitted to all four wheels.
car performs.

Direction of rotation Follow the recommended tyre pressures


specified in the tyre pressure table, see
page 264.

Tyre care

G021823
Tyre age
All tyres older than 6 years old should be
checked by an expert even if they seem Tyres are perishable. After a few years they
undamaged. Tyres age and decompose, even begin to harden at the same time as the friction
if they are hardly ever or never used. The func- capacity/characteristics gradually deteriorate.
For this reason, aim to get as fresh tyres as
G021778

tion can therefore be affected. This also applies


to spare tyres, winter tyres and tyres saved for possible when you replace them. This is espe-
The arrow shows the tyre's direction of rotation. future use. Examples of external signs which cially important with regard to winter tyres. The
06 last four digits in the sequence mean the week
indicate that the tyre is unsuitable for use are
Tyres with a tread pattern which are designed and year of manufacture. This is the tyre's
cracks or discoloration.
to only turn in one direction have the direction DOT marking (Department of Transportation),
of rotation marked with an arrow. The tyre must and this is stated with four digits, for example
always rotate in the same direction throughout 1502. The tyre in the illustration was manufac-
its lifespan. Tyres should only be switched tured in week 15 of 2002.
between front and rear positions, never
between left and right-hand sides, or vice Summer and winter tyres
versa. If the tyre is mounted incorrectly, the When summer and winter wheels are changed,
car's braking characteristics and capacity to see page 257, the wheels should be marked
force rain and slush out of the way are with which side of the car they were mounted
adversely affected. on, for example L for left and R for right.

254
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

Wear and maintenance Tyres with tread wear indicators Only use rims that are tested and approved by
The correct tyre pressure results in more even Volvo and which are Volvo genuine accesso-
wear, see page 263. Driving style, tyre pres- ries. Check the torque with a torque wrench.
sure, climate and road condition affect how
Locking wheel bolts
quickly your tyres age and wear. To avoid dif-
Locking wheel bolts can be used on both alu-
ferences in tread depth and to prevent wear
minium and steel rims.
patterns arising, the front and rear wheels can
be switched with each other. A suitable dis-
tance for the first change is approx. 5000 km Winter tyres
and then at 10 000 km intervals. Volvo recom- Volvo recommends winter tyres with particular
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo dimensions. Tyre dimensions are dependent

G021829
workshop for checking if you are uncertain on engine variant. When driving on winter tyres,
about tread depth. the correct tyres must be fitted to all four
Wheels should be stored lying down or hanging wheels.
Tread wear indicators are narrow treadless
up - and not standing up. bands across the width of the tread. On the
side of the tyre are the letters TWI (Tread Wear
NOTE
WARNING Indicator). When the tyre's tread depth is down Volvo recommends that you consult a Volvo
to 1.6 mm, the tread depth will be level in height dealer about which wheel rim and tyre types
A damaged tyre can lead to loss of control are most suitable.
of the car. with the tread wear indicators. Change to new
tyres as soon as possible. Remember that 06
tyres with little tread depth provide very poor Studded tyres
grip in rain and snow. Studded winter tyres should be run in gently for
500-1000 km so the studs settle properly into
Rims and wheel bolts the tyres. This gives the tyre, and especially the
studs, a longer service life.
IMPORTANT
The wheel bolts must be tightened to NOTE
140 Nm. Overtightening can damage the
nuts and the bolts. The legal provisions for the use of studded
tyres vary from country to country.

``

255
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

Tread depth IMPORTANT Spare wheel*


Road conditions with ice, slush and low tem- The spare wheel (Temporary spare) is only
peratures place considerably higher demands Only single-sided snow chains are permit-
ted. Use Volvo genuine snow chains or sim- intended for temporary use. Replace the spare
on tyres than summer conditions. Volvo there- ilar that are properly suited to the car model, wheel with a normal wheel as soon as possible.
fore recommends not to drive on winter tyres tyre size and wheel rim size. In the event of The car's handling may be altered by the use
that have a tread depth of less than 4 millime- uncertainty Volvo recommends that you of the spare wheel. The correct tyre pressure
tres. consult an authorised Volvo workshop. for the spare wheel is stated in the tyre pres-
sure table, see page 264.
Using snow chains
Tools IMPORTANT
Snow chains may only be used on the front
wheels (also applies to all-wheel drive cars). Never drive faster than 80 km/h with a spare
wheel on the car.
Never drive faster than 50 km/h with snow
chains. Avoid driving on bare ground as this
wears out both the snow chains and tyres. IMPORTANT
Never use quick-fit snow chains as the space
between the brake discs and the wheels is too The car must never be driven fitted with
more than one temporary spare wheel.
small.

IMPORTANT The spare wheel is located in the spare wheel


06
well with the outside down. Two foam blocks,
Use Volvo genuine snow chains or equiva- one under the spare wheel and one over/inside
lent chains designed specifically for the car affix the spare wheel in position. The upper one
model, and tyre and wheel rim dimensions. A foam block contains all the tools. The tools
In the event of uncertainty Volvo recom-
contains all tools.
consist of a towing eye, jack* and wheel
mends that you consult an authorised Volvo The same bolt runs through to secure the spare
workshop. wrench*. The foam block is screwed into a
bracket in the bottom of the spare wheel well. wheel and the foam blocks.

Jack* Taking out the spare wheel


The original jack should only be used for 1. Fold up the cargo area floor, from the rear
changing wheels. The jack's thread must and forwards.
always be well greased.

256 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

2. Undo the retaining screw. IMPORTANT WARNING


3. Lift out the foam block with its tools. The tools and jack* must be stored in the Check that the jack is not damaged, that the
4. Lift out the spare wheel. intended location in the car's cargo area threads are thoroughly lubricated and that it
when not in use. is free from dirt.
The lower foam block does not need to be lifted
out.
Changing wheels NOTE
Tools - returning into place
Volvo recommends only using the jack* that
Removing belongs to the car model in question.

2. Take out the spare wheel*, jack* and wheel


wrench* that are located under the cargo
area floor in the cargo area. If another jack
is selected, see page 228.
3. Place chocks in front of and behind the
wheels which will remain on the ground.
Use heavy wooden blocks or large stones.
G029336

06
The tools and jack* must be returned to their
correct places after use. The jack must be Set up the warning triangle, see page 217 if a
cranked together to the correct position in wheel must be replaced at a busy location. The
order to have space. car and jack* must be on a firm horizontal sur-
The foam block and spare wheel must be face.
replaced in the reverse order to taking out. 1. Apply the parking brake and engage first
Note that there is an arrow on the upper foam gear, or position P if the car has an auto-
block. It must point forwards in the car. matic gearbox.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 257


06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

4. Loosen the wheel nuts ½–1 turn anticlock- IMPORTANT ened properly. Tighten to 140 Nm. Check
wise with the wheel wrench. the torque with a torque wrench.
The jack mounting point is the rearmost of
the two rear recesses. 5. Fit on the wheel cover (for cars with steel
WARNING rims).
Never position anything between the 7. Lift the car so that the wheel is free.
ground and the jack, nor between the jack- NOTE
Remove the wheel bolts and lift off the
ing point and the jack.
wheel. The hubcap outlet for the valve must be
located over the valve on the rim when fit-
5. There are two jacking points on each side Installation ted.
of the car. There is a recess in the plastic 1. Clean the contact surfaces on wheels,
cover at each point. Crank the foot of the hubs and brake discs.
jack down so it is pressed squarely on the WARNING
2. Put on the wheel. Screw in the wheel bolts.
ground. Never crawl under the car when it is raised
3. Lower the car so that the wheels cannot on the jack.
6.
rotate.
Passengers must leave the car when it is
raised on the jack.
Park the car so that passengers have the car
- or preferably a crash barrier - between
them and the road.
06

G022916
Check that the jack sits in the anchorage as
4. Tighten the wheel bolts crosswise. It is
illustrated and that the foot is positioned
important that the wheel bolts are tight-
vertically under the anchorage.

258
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

Emergency puncture repair* The emergency puncture repair kit has limited WARNING
capacity to seal tyres which have punctures in
the wall. Do not seal tyres with the emergency You should not drive faster than80 km/h
puncture repair kit if they have larger slits, after the emergency tyre repair kit has been
used. Volvo recommends that you visit an
cracks or similar damage. authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of
12 V sockets for the compressor are located by the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance
the centre console in the front, by the rear seat is 200 km). The staff there can determine
whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if
and in the cargo area. Choose the electrical
it needs to be replaced.
socket that is nearest the punctured tyre.

Taking out the emergency puncture


Overview
repair kit
Set up the warning triangle adjacent to a traf-
ficked location. The emergency puncture
General repair kit is located under the floor in the cargo
The emergency puncture repair kit is used to area.
seal a puncture as well as to check and adjust
1. Raise the floor hatch in the cargo area floor.
the tyre pressure. It consists of a compressor
and a bottle with sealing fluid. The kit works as 2. Unscrew the retaining screw.
a temporary repair. The sealing fluid bottle 06
3. Lift away the foam block holding the jack*
must be replaced before its expiration date and
and wheel wrench*.
after use.
4. Lift up the emergency puncture repair kit.
The sealing fluid effectively seals tyres punc-
tured in the tread. Replace the parts after use.
Label, maximum permitted speed
NOTE Switch
The emergency puncture repair kit is only Cable
intended for sealing tyres with a puncture in
the tread. Bottle holder (orange cap)
Protective cap

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 259


06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

Pressure reducing valve 1. Open the lid of the emergency puncture WARNING
repair kit.
Air hose Do not leave children in the car without
2. Detach the label for maximum permitted supervision when the engine is running.
Sealing fluid bottle speed and affix it to the steering wheel.
Pressure gauge 7. Plug the cable into the 12 V socket and
WARNING start the car.
Sealing punctured tyres The sealing fluid can irritate the skin. In the
case of contact with skin, wash away the WARNING
fluid with soap and water.
Never stand next to the tyre when the com-
pressor is operating. If cracks or uneven-
3. Check that the switch is in position 0 and ness arise then the compressor must be
locate the cable and the air hose. switched off immediately. The journey
should not continue. Contacting an author-
NOTE ised tyre centre is recommended.

Do not break the bottle seal. The seal is bro-


ken when the bottle is screwed in. NOTE
When the compressor starts, the pressure
4. Unscrew the orange cap and unscrew the can increase up to 6 bar but the pressure
06 drops after approximately 30 seconds.
bottle's stopper.

WARNING 8. Flick the switch to position I.


Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped
with a reverse catch to prevent leakage. IMPORTANT
Risk of overheating. The compressor must
G014338

5. Screw the bottle into its holder. not run for more than 10 minutes.
6. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw
For information on the function of the parts, see in the air hose valve connection to the bot- 9. Inflate the tyre for 7 minutes.
preceding illustration.
tom of the thread on the tyre's air valve.

260
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

WARNING WARNING Rechecking the repair and pressure


1. Reconnect the equipment.
If the pressure is below 1.8 bar then the hole Inhaling car exhaust fumes can result in
in the tyre is too big. The journey should not danger to life. Never leave the engine run- 2. Read the tyre pressure on the pressure
continue. Contacting an authorised tyre ning in sealed areas or areas that lack suf- gauge.
centre is recommended. ficient ventilation.
• If it is below 1.3 bar then the tyre is
insufficiently sealed. The journey should
10. Switch off the compressor to check the WARNING not be continued. Contact a tyre centre.
pressure on the pressure gauge. Minimum
pressure is 1.8 bar and maximum is Do not leave children in the car without • If the tyre pressure is higher than 1.3
supervision when the engine is running. bar, the tyre must be inflated to the pres-
3.5 bar. sure specified on the tyre pressure
11. Switch off the compressor and unplug the label/table, see page 264. Release air
3. Connect the cable to one of the car's 12 V using the pressure reducing valve if the
cable from the 12 V socket.
sockets and start the car. tyre pressure is too high.
12. Detach the hose from the tyre valve and fit
4. Start the compressor by flicking the switch
the valve cap.
to position I. WARNING
13. As soon as possible, drive approximately
Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped
3 km at a maximum speed of 80 km/h so IMPORTANT with a reverse catch to prevent leakage.
that the sealing fluid can seal the tyre.
Risk of overheating. The compressor must
Inflating the tyres not run for more than 10 minutes. 3. Switch off the compressor. Detach the air 06
The car's original tyres can be inflated by the hose and cable. Refit the dust cap.
compressor. 5. Inflate the tyre to the pressure specified on 4. Return the emergency puncture repair kit
1. The compressor must be switched off. the tyre pressure label/table, see to the cargo area.
Make sure that the switch is in position 0 page 264. (Release air using the pressure
and locate the cable and air hose. reducing valve if the tyre pressure is too
NOTE
high.)
2. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw The sealing fluid bottle and hose must be
in the air hose valve connection to the bot- 6. Switch off the compressor. Detach the air replaced after use. Volvo recommends that
tom of the thread on the tyre's air valve. hose and cable. this replacement is performed by an author-
7. Refit the dust cap. ised Volvo workshop.

``

261
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

WARNING WARNING 103 Tyre load index


Check the tyre pressure regularly. The bottle contains 1.2-Ethanol and natural V Speed rating for maximum permitted
rubber-latex.
speed (in this case 270 km/h).
Volvo recommends that you drive to the near- Harmful if ingested. Could result in allergic
est authorised Volvo workshop for the replace- reaction in the event of skin contact. Speed ratings
ment/repair of the damaged tyre. Advise the Avoid contact with the skin and eyes. The car is approved as a whole, which means
workshop that the tyre contains sealing fluid. that tyre dimensions and speed ratings must
Store out of the reach of children.
not differ from those specified on the car's reg-
WARNING istration document.
NOTE
You should not drive faster than80 km/h The only exception to these conditions is win-
after the emergency tyre repair kit has been Leave the container at a collection point for ter tyres (both those with metal studs and those
used. Volvo recommends that you visit an storing dangerous waste. without). If such a tyre is chosen, the car must
authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of not be driven faster than the speed rating of the
the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance
tyre (for example, class Q can be driven at a
is 200 km). The staff there can determine Specifications
whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if maximum of 160 km/h).
it needs to be replaced. Designation of dimensions Traffic regulations determine how fast a car
The dimensions are stated on all car tyres. can be driven, not the speed rating of the tyres.
Replacing the sealing fluid canister Example of designation:
06
Replace the bottle when the expiration date 235/60 R18 103 V. Q 160 km/h (used only on winter tyres)
has passed. Treat the old bottle as environ-
mentally hazardous waste. T 190 km/h
235 Section width (mm)
H 210 km/h
60 Ratio between section height and
width (%) V 240 km/h

R Radial ply W 270 km/h

18 Rim diameter in inches (") Y 300 km/h

262
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

NOTE The tyre pressure label on the driver's side door


pillar (between front and rear door) shows
It is the maximum permitted speed that is which pressures the tyres should have at dif-
stated in the table. ferent loads and speed conditions, this is also
specified in the tyre pressure table, see below.
Tyre pressure
• Tyre pressure for the car's recommended
tyre dimension
• ECO pressure
• Spare wheel tyre pressure (Temporary
Spare)

NOTE
Temperature differences change the
tyre pressure.
G021830

06

``

263
06 Maintenance and service

Wheels and tyres

Recommended tyre pressure


Variant Tyre size Speed Load, 1 – 3 persons Max. load ECO pressureA
(km/h)
Front (kPa)B Rear (kPa) Front (kPa) Rear (kPa) Front/rear (kPa)
All engines 235/65 R 17 0 – 160 240 240 270 270 270
235/60 R 18 160 + 240 240 270 270 -
235/55 R 19

Spare wheelC T 125/80 R 17 max. 80 420 420 420 420 -


A Economical driving.
B In certain countries there is the "bar" unit beside the SI unit "Pascal": 1 bar = 100 kPa.
C Temporary spare.

Fuel economy, ECO pressure the car's roadholding. Driving on tyres with tyre
At speeds under 160 km/h, the general tyre pressure that is too low could result in the tyres
pressure is recommended (applies for full load overheating and being damaged. Tyre pres-
and light load) in order to obtain optimum fuel sure affects travelling comfort, road noise and
economy. steering characteristics.
06
Checking the tyre pressure NOTE
The tyre pressures must be checked every
month. This also applies to the car's spare Tyre pressure decreases over time, this is a
wheel. After several few kilometres of driving, natural phenomenon. Tyre pressure also
varies depending on ambient temperature.
the tyres warm up and the pressure increases.
Check tyre pressures on cold tyres. "Cold
tyres" means the tyres are the same tempera-
ture as the ambient temperature.
Inadequate tyre pressure increases fuel con-
sumption, shortens tyre lifespan and impairs

264
06 Maintenance and service

Car care

Washing the car IMPORTANT Automatic car washes


Wash the car as soon as it becomes dirty. An automatic car wash is a simple and quick
Dirty headlamps have impaired functional- way of washing the car, but it cannot reach
Wash the car in a car wash with oil separator. ity. Clean them regularly, when refuelling for
Use car shampoo. example. everywhere. Handwashing the car is recom-
mended for achieving optimum results.
• Remove bird droppings from the paintwork
as soon as possible. Bird droppings con-
NOTE NOTE
tain chemicals that affect and discolour
paintwork very quickly. An authorised Outside lighting such as headlamps, fog During the first few months a new car must
Volvo workshop is recommended for the lamps and rear lamps may temporarily have only be handwashed. This is because the
removal of any discoloration. condensation on the inside of the lens. This paintwork is more sensitive when it is new.
is a natural phenomenon, all outside lighting
• Hose down the underbody. is designed to withstand this. Condensation
• Rinse the entire car to remove loose dirt. is normally vented out of the lamp housing High-pressure washing
Do not spray directly onto the locks. when it has been switched on for a time. When using high-pressure washing, use
sweeping movements and make sure that the
• Wash using a sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of lukewarm water. Cleaning the wiper blades nozzle does not come closer than 30 cm to the
Asphalt, dust and salt residue on wiper blades, surface of the car (the distance applies to all
• Clean the wiper blades with a lukewarm
exterior parts). Do not spray directly onto the
soap solution or car shampoo. as well as insects, ice etc. on the windscreen,
impair the service life of wiper blades. locks.
• Use cold degreasing agent on very dirty
surfaces. For cleaning: Testing the brakes 06
• Dry the car using a clean, soft chamois or ± Set the wiper blades in service position,
a water scraper. see page 241. WARNING
Always test the brakes after washing the
WARNING NOTE car, including the parking brake, to ensure
that moisture and corrosion do not attack
Always have the engine cleaned by a work- Wash the wiper blades and windscreen reg- the brake linings and reduce braking per-
shop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is ularly with lukewarm soap solution or car formance.
hot. shampoo.
Do not use any strong solvents. Lightly depress the brake pedal now and then
when driving long distances in rain or slush.
The heat from the friction causes the brake lin-
``

265
06 Maintenance and service

Car care

ings to warm up and dry. Do the same thing Polishing and waxing Water-repellent coating*
after starting in very damp or cold weather. Polish and wax the car if the paintwork is dull Never use products such as car wax,
or to give the paintwork extra protection. degreaser or similar on glass surfa-
Exterior plastic, rubber and trim
ces as this could ruin their water-repellent
components The car does not need to be polished until it is
properties.
A special cleaning agent available from Volvo at least one year old. However, the car can be
dealers is recommended for cleaning coloured waxed during this time. Do not polish or wax Take care when cleaning so as not to damage
plastic parts, rubber and trim components, the car in direct sunlight. the glass surface.
such as glossy trim mouldings. When using Wash and dry the car thoroughly before you To avoid damaging glass surfaces when
such a cleaning agent the instructions must be begin polishing or waxing. Clean off asphalt removing ice – only use plastic ice scrapers.
followed carefully. and tar stains using Volvo tar remover or white
There is natural wear of the water-repellent
spirit. More stubborn stains can be removed
coating.
IMPORTANT using fine rubbing paste designed for car paint-
work. Treatment with a special finishing agent avail-
Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic and
rubber. able from Volvo dealers is recommended in
Polish first with a polish and then wax with liq-
order to maintain the water-repellent proper-
When using degreasant on plastic and rub- uid or solid wax. Follow the instructions on the
ties. This should be used first after three years
ber, only rub with light pressure if it is nec- packaging carefully. Many preparations con-
and then each year.
essary. Use a soft washing sponge. tain both polish and wax.
Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear
06 away or damage the glossy surface layer. IMPORTANT Rustproofing – inspection and
maintenance
Polishing agent that contains abrasive must Paint treatment such as preserving, sealing,
not be used. protection, lustre sealing or similar could The car received a thorough and complete
damage the paintwork. Paintwork damage rustproofing at the factory. Parts of the body
caused by such treatments is not covered are made of galvanised sheet metal. The
Rims by Volvo warranty. underbody is protected by a wear-resistant
Only use rim cleaning agent recommended by anti-corrosion compound. A thin, penetrating
Volvo. rustproofing fluid was sprayed into the
exposed members, cavities, closed sections
and side doors.

266 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 Maintenance and service

Car care

Under normal conditions the rustproofing does Treating stains on leather upholstery IMPORTANT
not require treatment for approximately 12 Volvo leather upholstery is chromium-free and
years. After this period, it should be treated at approved in accordance with the Oeko-Tex Note that materials with colour that runs
three-year intervals. Volvo recommends that when dry (new jeans, suede garments etc.)
100 standard. may discolour the upholstery material.
you engage an authorised Volvo workshop for
The leather is refined and processed so that it
assistance if the car needs further treatment.
retains its natural characteristics. It is given a Washing instructions for leather
Dirt and road salt can lead to corrosion so it is protective coating, but regular cleaning is
upholstery
important to keep the car clean. The car's rust- required in order to maintain both characteris-
1. Pour the leather cleaner on the dampened
proofing needs to be checked regularly and tics and appearance. Volvo offers a compre-
sponge and squeeze out a strong foam.
touched-up if necessary in order for it to be hensive product for the cleaning and treatment
maintained. of leather upholstery which, when used in 2. Work the dirt away with gentle circular
accordance with the instructions, preserves movements.
Cleaning the interior the leather's protective coating.After a period 3. Dab accurately with the sponge on the
of use the natural appearance of the leather will stains. Allow the sponge to absorb the
Only use cleaning agents and car care prod-
nevertheless emerge, depending more or less stain. Do not rub.
ucts recommended by Volvo. Clean regularly
on the surface texture of the leather. This is a
and follow the instructions included with the 4. Wipe off with soft paper or a cloth and
natural maturing of the leather and shows that
car care product. allow the leather to dry completely.
it is a natural product.
Stains on fabric upholstery and roof To achieve best results Volvo recommends Protective treatment of leather
upholstery 06
upholstery cleaning and application of the protective
A special fabric cleaning agent, available from cream once to four times per year (or more if 1. Pour a small amount of the protective
authorised Volvo dealers, is recommended to required). Ask a Volvo dealer about Volvo's cream on the felted cloth and massage in
avoid impairing the fire retardant qualities of Leather care product. a thin layer of cream with gentle circular
the upholstery. Use water and a synthetic movements on the leather.
detergent to clean the seatbelts. Make sure the IMPORTANT 2. Allow the leather to dry for 20 minutes
seatbelt is dry before allowing it to retract. before use.
Never use strong solvents. Such products
may damage fabric, vinyl and leather The leather has now been given improved pro-
IMPORTANT upholstery. tection against stains and improved UV pro-
Sharp objects and Velcro may damage the tection.
fabric upholstery.

``

267
06 Maintenance and service

Car care

Treating stains on interior plastic, metal Colour code Before work is begun, the car must be clean
and wood parts and dry and at a temperature above 15 °C.
A fibrillated fibre or microfibre cloth, lightly 1. Apply a piece of masking tape over the
moistened with water, available from Volvo damaged surface. Then remove the tape to
dealers, is recommended for cleaning interior remove any loose paint.
parts and surfaces.
2. Stir the primer well and apply using a fine
Do not scrape or rub stains. Never use strong brush or a matchstick. Apply paint using a
stain removers. A special cleaning agent avail- brush once the primer is dry.
able from Volvo dealers can be used for more
difficult cleaning. 3. For scratches, proceed as above, but
mask around the damaged area to protect
Carpets and cargo area the undamaged paintwork.
Remove inlaid carpets for separate cleaning of 4. After a few days, polish the touched-up
the floor carpet and the inlaid carpets. Use a Car colour code areas. Use a soft rag and a small amount
vacuum cleaner to remove dust and dirt. of lapping paste.
It is important that the correct colour is used.
For product decal location, see page 272.
Touching up paintwork NOTE
Paint is an important part of the car's rust- Repairing stone chips
If the stone chip has not penetrated to the
proofing and should therefore be checked reg- bare metal and there is an undamaged col-
06
ularly. To avoid the onset of rust, damaged our coat, you can paint straight after clean-
paintwork should be rectified immediately. The ing the damaged surface.
most common types of paintwork damage are
stone chips, scratches, and marks on the
edges of wings and doors.

Materials
• primer in a can
• paint in a can or touch-up pen

G021832
• brush
• masking tape

268
06 Maintenance and service

06

269
Type designations................................................................................. 272
Dimensions and weights....................................................................... 274
Engine specifications............................................................................ 277
Engine oil............................................................................................... 278
Fluids and lubricants............................................................................. 280
Fuel....................................................................................................... 282
Electrical system................................................................................... 283

G000000
Type approval....................................................................................... 284

270
SPECIFICATIONS

07
07 Specifications

Type designations

Label location

07

272
07 Specifications

Type designations

Knowing the car's type designation, vehicle NOTE


identification and engine numbers can facili-
tate all contact with an authorised Volvo dealer The labels shown in the owner's manual are
regarding the car and when ordering spare not provided as exact reproductions of
those in the car. The purpose is to show
parts and accessories. their approximate appearance and location
Type designation, vehicle identification in the car. The information that applies to
number, maximum permissible weights, your car in particular is available on the label
in question in your car.
codes for colour and upholstery and type
approval number.
Label for parking heater.
The engine oil label specifies oil grade and
viscosity.
Engine type designation, component and
serial number.
Gearbox type designation and serial num-
ber.
Manual gearbox
Automatic gearbox
Car's identification number. (VIN Vehicle
Identification Number)
Further information on the car is presented in 07
the registration document.

273
07 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

Dimensions

Dimensions mm Dimensions mm Weights


Kerb weight includes the driver, the fuel tank
A Wheelbase 2774 H Rear track 1586 90% full and all fluids.
B Length 4627 I Load width, floor 1090 The weight of passengers and accessories,
and towball load (when a trailer is hitched, see
C Load length, floor, folded J Width 1891 table) influences the payload and is not
07 rear seat 1789 included in the kerb weight.
K Width including door mir-
D Load length, floor 972 rors 2120 Permitted maximum load = Gross vehicle
weight - Kerb weight.
E Height 1713

F Load height 802

G Front track 1632

274
07 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

NOTE WARNING Max. load: See registration document.

The documented kerb weight applies to The car's driving characteristics change Max. roof load: 100 kg.
cars in the standard version - i.e. a car with- depending on how heavily it is loaded and
out extra equipment or accessories. This how the load is distributed.
means that for every accessory added the
loading capacity of the car is reduced cor-
respondingly by the weight of the acces-
sory.
Examples of accessories that reduce load-
ing capacity are the Kinetic/Momentum/
Summum equipment levels, as well as other
accessories such as Towbar, Load carriers,
Space box, Audio system, Auxiliary lamps,
GPS, Fuel-driven heater, Safety grille, Car-
pets, Cargo cover, Power seats, etc.
Weighing the car is a certain way of ascer-
taining the kerb weight of your own partic-
ular car.
For information on decal location, see page 272.
Gross vehicle weight
Max. train weight (car+trailer)
Max. front axle load
Max. rear axle load 07

Equipment level

``

275
07 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

Towing capacity and towball load


Engine Gearbox Max. weight braked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)
All All 0–1200 50

3.2 Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90

3.2 AWD Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90

T6 AWD Automatic, TF-80SC 2000 90

2.4D Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90

2.4D Manual, M66 1500 75

D5 AWD Automatic, TF-80SC 2000 90

D5 AWD Manual, M66 1800 90

2.4DA Automatic, TF-80SC 2000 90


A Only the Netherlands

Max. weight unbraked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)


750 50
07
NOTE
The use of a stabilising device is recom-
mended with a trailer heavier than 1800 kg.

276
07 Specifications

Engine specifications

Engine specifications
Model Engine Output Output Torque (Nm/ No. Bore Stroke Swept vol- Compres-
(kW/ (hp/rpm) rpm) of (mm) (mm) ume (litres) sion ratio
rpm) cyl-
in-
ders
T6 B6304T2 210/5600 285/5600 400/1500–4800 6 82 93.2 2,953 9.3:1

3,2 B6324S 175/6200 238/6200 320/3200 6 84 96,0 3,192 10.8:1

2.4D D5244T14 129/3000– 175/3000– 420/1500–2750 5 81 93.2 2.400 16,5:1


4000 4000

D5 D5244T10 151/4000 205/4000 420/1500–3250 5 81 93.2 2.400 16,5:1

2.4D D5244T16A 120/4000 163/4000 420/1750–3000 5 81 93.2 2.400 16,5:1


A Only the Netherlands

07

277
07 Specifications

Engine oil

Engine oil Volvo recommends Castrol oil products.

Adverse driving conditions IMPORTANT


Adverse driving conditions can lead to abnor-
mally high oil temperature or oil consumption. In order to fulfil the requirements for the
engine's service intervals all engines are
Check the oil level more frequently for long filled with a specially adapted synthetic
journeys: engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil
has been made very carefully with regard to
• towing a caravan or trailer service life, starting characteristics, fuel
• in mountainous regions consumption and environmental impact. An

G021834
approved engine oil must be used in order
• at high speeds
that the recommended service intervals can
• in temperatures colder than -30 °C or hot- be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of
ter than +40 °C oil (see the engine compartment decal) for Viscosity chart.
both filling and oil change, otherwise you
• shorter driving distances (shorter than
will risk affecting service life, starting cha-
10 km) at low temperatures (under 5 °C).
racteristics, fuel consumption and environ-
This can produce abnormally high oil tempera- mental impact. Volvo Car Corporation dis-
ture or oil consumption. claims all warranty liability if engine oil of the
prescribed grade and viscosity is not used.
Choose a fully synthetic engine oil for adverse
driving conditions. It provides extra protection
for the engine.

07

278
07 Specifications

Engine oil

Oil decal
Engine variant Volume between MIN and Volume
MAX (litres) (litres)
T6 B6304T2 1.2 7.4

3.2 B6324S 1.2 7.4

2.4D D5244T14 1.5 6.0

D5 D5244T10

G032078
When the label shown here is fitted in the car's
engine compartment then the following applies.
For information on decal location, see
page 229.
Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5
Viscosity: SAE 0W–30

07

279
07 Specifications

Fluids and lubricants

Other fluids and lubricants


Fluid System Volume (litres) Prescribed grade
Coolant Petrol engine T6 8.9
Coolant with corrosion inhibitor mixed
Diesel engine D5
12,6 with waterA, see packaging.
Diesel engine 2.4D

Refrigerant Air conditioning B R134a (HFC134a)


Oil: PAG

Brake fluid Brake system 0.6 DOT 4+

Power steering Power steering 1.2 WSS M2C204-A2 or equivalent prod-


uct.

Washer fluid Cars with headlamp washing 6.5 Use a washer antifreeze recommended
by Volvo, mixed with water.
Cars without headlamp washing 4,5
A Water quality must fulfil the standard STD 1285.1.
B Refrigerant quantity varies depending on engine variant. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop for the correct information.

Engine Gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid


07 T6 petrol Automatic, TF-80SC 7.0 JWS 3309

2.4D diesel Manual, M66 1.9 BOT 350M3

2.4D diesel Automatic, TF-80SC 7.0 JWS 3309

280
07 Specifications

Fluids and lubricants

Engine Gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid


D5 diesel Manual, M66 1.9 BOT 350M3

D5 diesel Automatic, TF-80SC 7.0 JWS 3309

NOTE
Under normal driving conditions, the gear-
box oil does not need to be changed during
its service life. However, this may be nec-
essary under adverse driving conditions,
see page 280.

07

281
07 Specifications

Fuel

CO2 emissions, fuel consumption and tank volume


Emissions of car-
bon dioxide (CO2, Consumption
Model Engine Gearbox Tank volume (litres)
(litre/100 km)
g/km)
T6 B6304T2 Automatic (TF–80SC) AWD 274 11,7 approx. 70

3.2 B6324S Automatic (TF–80SC) AWD 267 11,2 approx. 70

D5 D5244T10 Manual (M66) AWD 183 6.9 approx. 70

D5 D5244T10 Automatic (TF–80SC) AWD 199 7,5 approx. 70

2.4D D5244T14 Manual (M66) 159 6.0 approx. 70

2.4D D5244T14 Automatic (TF-80SC) 183 6.9 approx. 70

2.4DA D5244T16 Automatic (TF–80SC) AWD 199 7,5 approx. 70


A Only the Netherlands

Fuel consumption and emissions of


carbon dioxide
Official fuel consumption figures are based on
a standard driving cycle in accordance with EU
07 Directive 80/1268/ EEC comb. and 92/21/EEC.
The manner in which the car is driven, and
other non-technical factors affect fuel con-
sumption. For more information, see page 10.
See page 209 for more information on fuel.

282
07 Specifications

Electrical system

Electrical system IMPORTANT


12 V system with a voltage-regulated alterna-
If the battery is replaced, replace it with a
tor. Single pole system in which the chassis battery of the same cold start capacity and
and engine block are used as conductors. The reserve capacity as the original (see the
negative terminal is connected to the chassis. decal on the battery).

Battery
Engine Voltage (V) Cold start capacity, Reserve capacity
CCA - Cold Cranking Amperes (A) (minutes)
T6 12 520-700 100-135

D5, 2.4D 12 700-800 135-160

07

283
07 Specifications

Type approval

Remote control system


Country
A, B, CY, CZ, D, DK,
E, EST, F, FIN, GB, Delphi hereby
GR, H, I, IRL, L, LT, certifies that this
LV, M, NL, P, PL, S, remote control key
SK, SLO system conforms to
the essential char-
IS, LI, N, CH
acteristic require-
HR ments and other rel-
evant regulations of
directive 1999/5/EC.

ROK Delphi 2003-07-15,


Germany R-
LPD1-03-0151

BR

07
RC

CCAB06LP1940T4

284
07 Specifications

07

285
08 Alphabetical Index

A Alarm.......................................................... 59 Auto
alarm indicator...................................... 59 climate control settings...................... 129
ACC – Adaptive cruise control................. 156 alarm signals......................................... 60 Automatic car washes............................. 265
Active Bending Lights (ABL)...................... 81 arming................................................... 59
Automatic gearbox.................................. 103
checking the alarm............................... 46
Active chassis – FOUR-C........................ 154 manual gear positions (Geartronic)..... 104
deactivating.......................................... 59
Active Dual Xenon lights............................ 81 towing and recovery........................... 224
deactivating a triggered alarm.............. 60
Adapting driving characteristics.............. 154 reduced alarm level.............................. 60 Automatic locking...................................... 53

Adaptive cruise control............................ 156 temporary disarming of the alarm........ 60 Automatic relocking................................... 53
fault tracing......................................... 160 Allergy and asthma inducing sub- AUX.......................................................... 137
radar sensor........................................ 159 stances.................................................... 127 Auxiliary heater........................................ 136
Adaptive cruise control fault tracing........ 160 All-wheel drive, AWD............................... 107 AWD, All-wheel drive............................... 107
Additional heater (Diesel)......................... 136 All Wheel Drive (AWD).............................. 107
Adjusting headlamp pattern...................... 86 Approach light, duration............................ 85
Active Dual Xenon headlamps.............. 86 Audio B
halogen headlamp................................ 86 headphones socket............................ 138
Backrest..................................................... 75
Adjusting the steering wheel...................... 79 rear control panel................................ 138
front seat, lowering............................... 75
Airbag settings............................................... 138
surround............................................. 137 Backrest rear seat, lowering...................... 77
activating/deactivating, PACOS........... 22
driver's and front passenger side......... 20 Audio system........................................... 137 Battery............................................. 243, 283
functions............................................. 138 maintenance....................................... 243
Air conditioning........................................ 130
overview.............................................. 137 remote control key/PCC....................... 49
general................................................ 126
start assistance................................... 102
Air conditioning, AC................................. 130 Audio volume
symbols on the battery....................... 243
08 phone.................................................. 196
Air distribution.................................. 127, 132 warning symbols................................. 243
phone/media player............................ 196
Air vents................................................... 128 ring signal, phone............................... 196 Blind spot (BLIS)...................................... 187

286
08 Alphabetical Index

Blind Spot Information System, BLIS...... 187 C Checking and topping up the coolant..... 231
Bluetooth Children..................................................... 32
handsfree............................................ 194 Calls child safety locks.................................. 37
mute microphone............................... 196 functions during a call................ 199, 200 child seats and side airbags................. 24
transfer call to mobile......................... 196 incoming..................................... 195, 199 location in the car................................. 32
operation..................................... 195, 199 safety.................................................... 32
Bonnet, opening...................................... 228
volume in phone................................. 200
Brake and clutch fluid.............................. 232 Child safety locks...................................... 58
waiting................................................ 200
Brake light.................................................. 82 Child seat................................................... 32
Call waiting.............................................. 200
Brakes...................................................... 108 Child seats................................................. 32
Camera sensor................................ 166, 172
anti-lock braking system, ABS........... 108 integrated two-stage booster cushion. 35
Car care................................................... 265 ISOFIX fixture system for child seats. . . 37
brake light............................................. 82
brake system...................................... 108 Car care, leather upholstery.................... 267 recommended...................................... 33
electric parking brake......................... 112 Cargo area size classes for child seats with the ISO-
emergency brake assistance, EBA..... 108 cargo cover......................................... 216 FIX fixture system................................. 38
emergency brake lights........................ 82 lighting.................................................. 85 upper mounting points for child seats.. 40
filling brake fluid.................................. 232 mounting points.................................. 212 Cigarette lighter socket............................ 192
symbols in the combined instrument safety grille.......................................... 215 City Safety™............................................ 165
panel................................................... 108 safety net............................................ 213
Cleaning
Built-in phone.......................................... 199 Cargo cover............................................. 216 automatic car washes......................... 265
Bulbs, see Lighting.................................. 234 Car upholstery......................................... 267 car wash............................................. 265
Car wash.................................................. 265 rims..................................................... 266
seatbelts............................................. 267
Catalytic converter................................... 209
upholstery........................................... 267
recovery.............................................. 224
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)........ 127 08
Centre console........................................ 120
Chassis settings...................................... 154

287
08 Alphabetical Index

Climate control........................................ 126 D Driving with a trailer


general................................................ 126 towball load........................................ 274
sensors............................................... 126 DAB, menu structure............................... 148 towing capacity.................................. 274
Clock, setting............................................. 72 DAB Radio............................................... 147 DSTC, see also Stability control system.. 152
Collision..................................................... 31 Deadlocks.................................................. 56
Collision warning..................................... 170 deactivation.......................................... 56

Collision warning system


temporary deactivation......................... 56 E
radar sensor........................ 159, 165, 170 Defroster.................................................. 130
ECC, electronic climate control............... 128
Collision Warning with Auto Brake*......... 170 Diesel....................................................... 210
Economical driving.................................. 206
Colour code, paint................................... 268 Diesel particle filter.................................. 210
ECO pressure.......................................... 263
Combined instrument panel.................... 123 Direction indicators.................................... 83
Electrical socket...................................... 193
Comfort inside the passenger compart- Disengaging the gear selector inhibitor... 106 cargo area........................................... 193
ment......................................................... 191 Display lighting.......................................... 80 front seat............................................. 193
Compass................................................... 97 Distance Alert.......................................... 162 Electric parking brake.............................. 112
calibration............................................. 97 Dolby Surround Pro Logic II.................... 137 low battery voltage............................. 112
Condensation in headlamps.................... 265 releasing automatically....................... 113
Door mirrors............................................... 94
releasing manually.............................. 113
Controls Driver Alert Control.................................. 175
centre console.................................... 120 Emergency calls...................................... 199
Driver Alert System.................................. 175
Crash, see Collision................................... 31 Emergency equipment
Driving...................................................... 206 warning triangle.................................. 217
Cruise control.......................................... 155 cooling system.................................... 206
Emergency puncture repair..................... 259
Curtain with the tailgate open......................... 206
panorama roof...................................... 98 with trailer........................................... 218 Emissions of carbon dioxide................... 211
08
CZIP (Clear Zone Interior Package)......... 127 Driving in water........................................ 206 Engine
overheating......................................... 218
starting................................................ 100

288
08 Alphabetical Index

Engine block heater External dimensions................................ 274 Fuse box.................................................. 246


fuel-driven........................................... 133 glovebox............................................. 250
Engine braking, automatic....................... 110 Fuses....................................................... 246
Engine compartment F box in cargo area................................ 252
coolant................................................ 231 changing............................................. 246
Fan........................................................... 129 general................................................ 246
oil........................................................ 230
overview.............................................. 229 Fault tracing for the camera sensor. 167, 173 relay/fuse box in engine compart-
power steering fluid............................ 232 First aid equipment.................................. 217 ment.................................................... 247

Engine oil......................................... 229, 278 Floor mats................................................ 192 Fuse table


adverse driving conditions.................. 278 fuses in cargo area............................. 252
Fluids, capacities..................................... 280
capacities........................................... 278 fuses in engine compartment............. 248
Fluids and oils.......................................... 280
filter..................................................... 230
oil grade.............................................. 278 FM, menu structure................................. 146
Engine specifications............................... 277 Fog lamp G
front...................................................... 82
Environmental labelling, FSC, owner's Gearbox
manual....................................................... 12 Fog lamps
automatic............................................ 103
rear........................................................ 83
Error messages Gear selector inhibitor............................. 105
Driver Alert Control............................. 176 Fog lamps, on/off...................................... 82
Gear selector inhibitor, mechanical disen-
Lane Departure Warning..................... 179 Foot brake............................................... 108
gagement................................................. 106
see Messages and symbols............... 160
FOUR-C – Active chassis........................ 154
Geartronic................................................ 104
Error messages in BLIS........................... 189
FSC, environmental labelling..................... 12
Glass
Error messages in Distance Alert............ 163
Fuel.......................................................... 209 laminated/reinforced............................. 92
Error messages in the Adaptive cruise con- fuel consumption................................ 282
Global opening........................................ 126 08
trol............................................................ 160 fuel economy.............................. 263, 264
fuel filter.............................................. 210 Glovebox................................................. 192
Expectant mothers, seatbelt...................... 17
locking.................................................. 54

289
08 Alphabetical Index

Gross vehicle weight............................... 274 HomeLinkŸ EU........................................ 115 Instruments and controls........................... 64
Home safe lighting..................................... 85 Interior lighting, see Lighting..................... 84
Hoot........................................................... 79 Interior rearview mirror............................... 95
H Horn........................................................... 79 automatic dimming............................... 95

Hazard warning flashers............................ 83 Intermittent wiping..................................... 89

HBS – Heart Beat Sensor.......................... 47 iPodŸ, connection................................... 140

HDC......................................................... 110
I
Headlamp levelling.................................... 80 IAQS – Interior Air Quality System........... 127
J
Headlamp pattern, adjusting..................... 86 IC – Inflatable Curtain................................ 26
Headlamps............................................... 234 IDIS – Intelligent Driver Information Sys- Jack......................................................... 256

Headphones socket................................. 138 tem........................................................... 201


Ignition keys............................................... 73
Head restraint
centre seat, rear.................................... 77 IMEI number............................................ 201
K
lowering................................................ 77 Immobiliser................................................ 44 Kerb weight.............................................. 274
Heated washer nozzles.............................. 90 Indicator lamps, PCC................................ 46 Key............................................................. 44
Heating.................................................... 130 Inflatable curtain........................................ 26 Key blade................................................... 47
rearview and door mirrors.................... 95
Information and warning symbols............. 68 Keyless drive...................................... 51, 100
rear window.......................................... 95
seats................................................... 129 Information button, PCC............................ 46 Keyless start (keyless drive)............... 51, 100
heat reflecting (Windscreen)...................... 92 Information displays.................................. 67 Keylock.................................................... 105
Heat-reflecting windscreen........................ 92 Instrument lighting, see Lighting................ 80 Keypad in the steering
08 Instrument overview wheel................................. 79, 120, 155, 199
High engine temperature......................... 218
left-hand drive....................................... 64 Key positions............................................. 73
High-pressure headlamp washing............. 90
right-hand drive.................................... 66
Hill Descent Control................................. 110

290
08 Alphabetical Index

L direction indicators............................. 236 M


fog lamp.............................................. 237
Labels...................................................... 272 main beam, Xenon lamp..................... 236 Main/dipped beam, see Lightning............. 80
Laminated glass......................................... 92 main beam halogen............................ 236 Maintenance
number plate lighting.......................... 238 rustproofing........................................ 266
Lamps, see Lighting................................ 234
side marker lamps.............................. 237
Lane Departure Control........................... 178 Making calls..................................... 195, 199
vanity mirror........................................ 239
Leather upholstery, washing instructions 267 Manual gearbox
Light switches............................................ 80
towing and recovery........................... 224
Lighting.................................................... 234 Loading
Active Dual Xenon lights....................... 81 Manual gear positions (Geartronic).......... 104
cargo area........................................... 212
approach light, duration....................... 85 general................................................ 212 Memory function in seats.......................... 76
automatic lighting, passenger compart- mounting points.................................. 212 Menus and messages.............................. 120
ment...................................................... 85 roof load............................................. 216 Menu structure
bulbs, specifications........................... 240
Locking/unlocking DAB.................................................... 148
controls................................................. 84
inside.................................................... 53 FM....................................................... 146
display lighting...................................... 80
tailgate............................................ 45, 54 Messages and symbols
front fog lamps..................................... 82
headlamp levelling................................ 80 Locks Collision Warning with Auto
home safe lighting................................ 85 automatic locking................................. 53 Brake.......................................... 168, 173
in passenger compartment................... 84 locking.................................................. 53 Distance Alert..................................... 163
instrument lighting................................ 80 unlocking.............................................. 53 Driver Alert Control............................. 176
main/dipped beam............................... 80 Lubricants................................................ 280 Lane Departure Warning..................... 179
position/parking lamps......................... 82 Lubricants, capacities.............................. 280 Messages and symbols in the Adaptive
rear fog lamp........................................ 83 cruise control........................................... 160
Lighting, bulb replacement...................... 234 Messages in BLIS.................................... 189
08
cargo area........................................... 239 Messages in the combined instrument
courtesy lighting................................. 239 panel........................................................ 123
dipped beam halogen......................... 235

291
08 Alphabetical Index

Messages in the information display....... 152 P Passenger compartment heater


Meters in the combined instrument panel fuel-driven........................................... 133
fuel gauge............................................. 68 PACOS....................................................... 22 PCC – Personal Car Communicator
speedometer......................................... 68 PACOS, switch.......................................... 22 functions............................................... 45
tachometer........................................... 68 Paintwork range............................................... 46, 47
Misting..................................................... 130 colour code......................................... 268 Petrol grade............................................. 209
attending to the windows................... 126 damage and touch-up........................ 268 Phone
condensation in headlamps............... 265 Panel lighting............................................. 80 built-in, overview................................ 199
remove with the air vents................... 132 connect............................................... 197
Panic function............................................ 45
timer function...................................... 130 handsfree............................................ 194
Panorama roof
Mobile phone incoming calls..................................... 195
curtain................................................... 98
connect............................................... 197 making calls........................................ 195
opening and closing............................. 98
handsfree............................................ 194 messages........................................... 201
ventilation position................................ 99
register phone..................................... 194 on/off.................................................. 199
Park assist camera.................................. 184 phone book......................................... 197
Parking assistance................................... 181 phone book, shortcut......................... 197
O parking assistance sensors................ 183 receiving a call....................................
register phone.....................................
196
194
Parking brake........................................... 112
Oil, see also Engine oil............................. 278 ring signal........................................... 200
Parking heater.......................................... 133
Oil level low.............................................. 230 SIM card............................................. 202
battery and fuel................................... 133
Overheating............................................. 218 parking on a hill.................................. 133 Phone book............................................. 200

Owner's manual, environmental labelling.. 12 time setting......................................... 135 Polishing.................................................. 266


Particle filter............................................. 210 Position/parking lamps.............................. 82
08 Passenger compartment......................... 191 Power panorama roof................................ 98
Passenger compartment filter................. 127 Power seat................................................. 75
Power windows......................................... 92

292
08 Alphabetical Index

Puncture, see Tyres................................. 256 Refuelling................................................. 208 ROPS (Roll Over Protection System) (Roll-
Putting calls on hold................................ 200 fuel cap............................................... 208 over protection).......................................... 29
fuel filler flap, electrical opening......... 208 Rustproofing............................................ 266
fuel filler flap, manual opening............ 208

R
refuelling............................................. 208
Relay/fuse box: see Fuses....................... 246
S
Radar sensor........................................... 156 Remote control
limitations........................................... 159 programmable.................................... 115 Safety grille.............................................. 215
Rain sensor................................................ 89 Remote control, see Remote control key. . 44 Safety mode.............................................. 31
Rear bulbs Remote control key................................... 44 Safety net................................................. 213
location............................................... 238 battery replacement.............................. 49 Seat, see Seats.......................................... 75
Rear control panel detachable key blade........................... 44 Seatbelt
audio system...................................... 138 functions............................................... 45 rear seat................................................ 17
Rearview and door mirrors range..................................................... 46 seatbelt tensioner................................. 18
compass............................................... 97 Remote control key system, type appro- Seatbelt reminder...................................... 17
door...................................................... 94 val............................................................ 284
Seatbelts.................................................... 16
electrically retractable........................... 94 Resetting the door mirrors......................... 95
heating.................................................. 95 Seats.......................................................... 75
Resetting the power windows................... 93 head restraints, rear.............................. 77
interior................................................... 95
Retractable power door mirrors................. 94 heating................................................ 129
Rear window, defrosting............................ 95
Reverse gear inhibitor.............................. 103 lowering the front backrest................... 75
Recirculation............................................ 130 lowering the rear backrest.................... 77
Rims
Recommendations during driving............ 206 power seats.......................................... 75
cleaning.............................................. 266
Recommended child seats, table.............. 33 Securing loads (Loading)......................... 212
Roll-over protection................................... 29 08
Recovery.................................................. 225 Service programme................................. 228
ROPS (Roll Over Protection System)......... 29
Refrigerant............................................... 126 Set time interval....................................... 162

293
08 Alphabetical Index

Side airbags............................................... 24 keypad, adaptive cruise control......... 157 T


Signal input, external............................... 137 steering wheel adjustment.................... 79
Stone chips and scratches...................... 268 Tailgate...................................................... 55
SIM card.................................................. 202
locking/unlocking............................ 45, 54
SIPS bag – decal....................................... 25 Storage spaces in the passenger compart-
open...................................................... 55
ment......................................................... 191
SIPS bags.................................................. 24 Temperature
Surround.................................................. 137
Soot filter................................................. 211 actual temperature............................. 126
Symbols................................................... 152
Soot filter full............................................ 211 Temperature control................................ 130
indicator symbols................................. 68
Spare wheel............................................. 256 information symbols............................. 68 Timer........................................................ 130
temporary spare................................. 256 warning symbols................................... 68 Tools........................................................ 256
Spin control............................................. 152 Symbols and messages Total airing function........................... 53, 126
Spin control function............................... 152 Collision Warning with Auto Towball
SRS Airbag.......................................... 20, 21 Brake.......................................... 168, 173 installation........................................... 220
Distance Alert..................................... 163 removal............................................... 222
SRS system............................................... 19
Driver Alert Control............................. 176
switch................................................... 22 Towbar, see Towing equipment.............. 219
Lane Departure Warning..................... 179
Stability and traction control system....... 152 Towing..................................................... 224
Symbols and messages in the Adaptive
Stability system....................................... 152 towing eye.......................................... 224
cruise control........................................... 160
Stains....................................................... 267 Towing capacity....................................... 274

Start assistance....................................... 102 Towing equipment................................... 219


specifications...................................... 220
Steering force, speed related.................. 154
Towing eye.............................................. 224
Steering force level, see Steering force... 154
Trailer....................................................... 218
08 Steering lock............................................ 101
cable................................................... 218
Steering wheel........................................... 79 driving with a trailer............................ 218
keypad.................. 79, 120, 137, 155, 199 snaking............................................... 222

294
08 Alphabetical Index

Trailer Stability Assist.............................. 222 V Washer nozzles, heated............................. 90


Transponder.............................................. 92 Washers
Vanity mirror...................................... 84, 193 rear window.......................................... 90
Trip computer.......................................... 150
Ventilation................................................ 127 washer fluid, filling.............................. 242
Trip meter.................................................. 71
Vibration damper..................................... 219 windscreen........................................... 90
Type approval, remote control key sys-
Water and dirt-repellent coating................ 92
tem........................................................... 284
Water-repellent surface, cleaning............ 266
Type designation..................................... 272
W Waxing..................................................... 266
Tyres
direction of rotation............................ 254 Warning lamp Weights
driving characteristics......................... 254 adaptive cruise control....................... 156 kerb weight......................................... 274
maintenance....................................... 254 collision warning system.................... 170 Wheels
pressure.............................................. 263 stability and traction control system. . 152 changing............................................. 257
puncture repair................................... 259 Warning lamps installation........................................... 258
specifications...................................... 262 airbags SRS.......................................... 69 rims..................................................... 255
speed ratings...................................... 262 alternator not charging......................... 69 snow chains........................................ 256
tread wear indicators.......................... 255 fault in brake system............................ 69 spare wheel........................................ 256
winter tyres......................................... 255 low oil pressure..................................... 69 Wheels and tyres..................................... 254
parking brake applied........................... 69 Whiplash injury, WHIPS............................. 27
seatbelt reminder.................................. 69
U warning................................................. 69
WHIPS
child seat/booster cushion................... 27
Warning sound whiplash injury...................................... 27
Unlocking
collision warning system.................... 170
from the inside...................................... 53 Windows, rearview and door mirrors......... 92
from the outside................................... 53 Warning symbol, AIRBAG system............. 19
Windscreen................................................ 92 08
USB, connection...................................... 140 Warning triangle....................................... 217
Windscreen washing.................................. 90
Washer fluid, filling................................... 242

295
08 Alphabetical Index

Windscreen wipers.................................... 89
rain sensor............................................ 89
Winter driving........................................... 207
Winter tyres.............................................. 255
Wiper blades............................................ 241
changing............................................. 241
cleaning.............................................. 242
replacing, rear window....................... 242
service position................................... 241
Wipers and washing.................................. 89

08

296
Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dcIE&%..):c\a^h]!6I%.'%!Eg^ciZY^cHlZYZc!<ŽiZWdg\'%%.!8deng^\]i'%%%"'%%.Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dc

Potrebbero piacerti anche